7606 lines
229 KiB
C
7606 lines
229 KiB
C
/*-------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
*
|
|
* postgres_fdw.c
|
|
* Foreign-data wrapper for remote PostgreSQL servers
|
|
*
|
|
* Portions Copyright (c) 2012-2022, PostgreSQL Global Development Group
|
|
*
|
|
* IDENTIFICATION
|
|
* contrib/postgres_fdw/postgres_fdw.c
|
|
*
|
|
*-------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
*/
|
|
#include "postgres.h"
|
|
|
|
#include <limits.h>
|
|
|
|
#include "access/htup_details.h"
|
|
#include "access/sysattr.h"
|
|
#include "access/table.h"
|
|
#include "catalog/pg_class.h"
|
|
#include "catalog/pg_opfamily.h"
|
|
#include "commands/defrem.h"
|
|
#include "commands/explain.h"
|
|
#include "commands/vacuum.h"
|
|
#include "executor/execAsync.h"
|
|
#include "foreign/fdwapi.h"
|
|
#include "funcapi.h"
|
|
#include "miscadmin.h"
|
|
#include "nodes/makefuncs.h"
|
|
#include "nodes/nodeFuncs.h"
|
|
#include "optimizer/appendinfo.h"
|
|
#include "optimizer/clauses.h"
|
|
#include "optimizer/cost.h"
|
|
#include "optimizer/inherit.h"
|
|
#include "optimizer/optimizer.h"
|
|
#include "optimizer/pathnode.h"
|
|
#include "optimizer/paths.h"
|
|
#include "optimizer/planmain.h"
|
|
#include "optimizer/prep.h"
|
|
#include "optimizer/restrictinfo.h"
|
|
#include "optimizer/tlist.h"
|
|
#include "parser/parsetree.h"
|
|
#include "postgres_fdw.h"
|
|
#include "storage/latch.h"
|
|
#include "utils/builtins.h"
|
|
#include "utils/float.h"
|
|
#include "utils/guc.h"
|
|
#include "utils/lsyscache.h"
|
|
#include "utils/memutils.h"
|
|
#include "utils/rel.h"
|
|
#include "utils/sampling.h"
|
|
#include "utils/selfuncs.h"
|
|
|
|
PG_MODULE_MAGIC;
|
|
|
|
/* Default CPU cost to start up a foreign query. */
|
|
#define DEFAULT_FDW_STARTUP_COST 100.0
|
|
|
|
/* Default CPU cost to process 1 row (above and beyond cpu_tuple_cost). */
|
|
#define DEFAULT_FDW_TUPLE_COST 0.01
|
|
|
|
/* If no remote estimates, assume a sort costs 20% extra */
|
|
#define DEFAULT_FDW_SORT_MULTIPLIER 1.2
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Indexes of FDW-private information stored in fdw_private lists.
|
|
*
|
|
* These items are indexed with the enum FdwScanPrivateIndex, so an item
|
|
* can be fetched with list_nth(). For example, to get the SELECT statement:
|
|
* sql = strVal(list_nth(fdw_private, FdwScanPrivateSelectSql));
|
|
*/
|
|
enum FdwScanPrivateIndex
|
|
{
|
|
/* SQL statement to execute remotely (as a String node) */
|
|
FdwScanPrivateSelectSql,
|
|
/* Integer list of attribute numbers retrieved by the SELECT */
|
|
FdwScanPrivateRetrievedAttrs,
|
|
/* Integer representing the desired fetch_size */
|
|
FdwScanPrivateFetchSize,
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* String describing join i.e. names of relations being joined and types
|
|
* of join, added when the scan is join
|
|
*/
|
|
FdwScanPrivateRelations
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Similarly, this enum describes what's kept in the fdw_private list for
|
|
* a ModifyTable node referencing a postgres_fdw foreign table. We store:
|
|
*
|
|
* 1) INSERT/UPDATE/DELETE statement text to be sent to the remote server
|
|
* 2) Integer list of target attribute numbers for INSERT/UPDATE
|
|
* (NIL for a DELETE)
|
|
* 3) Length till the end of VALUES clause for INSERT
|
|
* (-1 for a DELETE/UPDATE)
|
|
* 4) Boolean flag showing if the remote query has a RETURNING clause
|
|
* 5) Integer list of attribute numbers retrieved by RETURNING, if any
|
|
*/
|
|
enum FdwModifyPrivateIndex
|
|
{
|
|
/* SQL statement to execute remotely (as a String node) */
|
|
FdwModifyPrivateUpdateSql,
|
|
/* Integer list of target attribute numbers for INSERT/UPDATE */
|
|
FdwModifyPrivateTargetAttnums,
|
|
/* Length till the end of VALUES clause (as an Integer node) */
|
|
FdwModifyPrivateLen,
|
|
/* has-returning flag (as a Boolean node) */
|
|
FdwModifyPrivateHasReturning,
|
|
/* Integer list of attribute numbers retrieved by RETURNING */
|
|
FdwModifyPrivateRetrievedAttrs
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Similarly, this enum describes what's kept in the fdw_private list for
|
|
* a ForeignScan node that modifies a foreign table directly. We store:
|
|
*
|
|
* 1) UPDATE/DELETE statement text to be sent to the remote server
|
|
* 2) Boolean flag showing if the remote query has a RETURNING clause
|
|
* 3) Integer list of attribute numbers retrieved by RETURNING, if any
|
|
* 4) Boolean flag showing if we set the command es_processed
|
|
*/
|
|
enum FdwDirectModifyPrivateIndex
|
|
{
|
|
/* SQL statement to execute remotely (as a String node) */
|
|
FdwDirectModifyPrivateUpdateSql,
|
|
/* has-returning flag (as a Boolean node) */
|
|
FdwDirectModifyPrivateHasReturning,
|
|
/* Integer list of attribute numbers retrieved by RETURNING */
|
|
FdwDirectModifyPrivateRetrievedAttrs,
|
|
/* set-processed flag (as a Boolean node) */
|
|
FdwDirectModifyPrivateSetProcessed
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Execution state of a foreign scan using postgres_fdw.
|
|
*/
|
|
typedef struct PgFdwScanState
|
|
{
|
|
Relation rel; /* relcache entry for the foreign table. NULL
|
|
* for a foreign join scan. */
|
|
TupleDesc tupdesc; /* tuple descriptor of scan */
|
|
AttInMetadata *attinmeta; /* attribute datatype conversion metadata */
|
|
|
|
/* extracted fdw_private data */
|
|
char *query; /* text of SELECT command */
|
|
List *retrieved_attrs; /* list of retrieved attribute numbers */
|
|
|
|
/* for remote query execution */
|
|
PGconn *conn; /* connection for the scan */
|
|
PgFdwConnState *conn_state; /* extra per-connection state */
|
|
unsigned int cursor_number; /* quasi-unique ID for my cursor */
|
|
bool cursor_exists; /* have we created the cursor? */
|
|
int numParams; /* number of parameters passed to query */
|
|
FmgrInfo *param_flinfo; /* output conversion functions for them */
|
|
List *param_exprs; /* executable expressions for param values */
|
|
const char **param_values; /* textual values of query parameters */
|
|
|
|
/* for storing result tuples */
|
|
HeapTuple *tuples; /* array of currently-retrieved tuples */
|
|
int num_tuples; /* # of tuples in array */
|
|
int next_tuple; /* index of next one to return */
|
|
|
|
/* batch-level state, for optimizing rewinds and avoiding useless fetch */
|
|
int fetch_ct_2; /* Min(# of fetches done, 2) */
|
|
bool eof_reached; /* true if last fetch reached EOF */
|
|
|
|
/* for asynchronous execution */
|
|
bool async_capable; /* engage asynchronous-capable logic? */
|
|
|
|
/* working memory contexts */
|
|
MemoryContext batch_cxt; /* context holding current batch of tuples */
|
|
MemoryContext temp_cxt; /* context for per-tuple temporary data */
|
|
|
|
int fetch_size; /* number of tuples per fetch */
|
|
} PgFdwScanState;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Execution state of a foreign insert/update/delete operation.
|
|
*/
|
|
typedef struct PgFdwModifyState
|
|
{
|
|
Relation rel; /* relcache entry for the foreign table */
|
|
AttInMetadata *attinmeta; /* attribute datatype conversion metadata */
|
|
|
|
/* for remote query execution */
|
|
PGconn *conn; /* connection for the scan */
|
|
PgFdwConnState *conn_state; /* extra per-connection state */
|
|
char *p_name; /* name of prepared statement, if created */
|
|
|
|
/* extracted fdw_private data */
|
|
char *query; /* text of INSERT/UPDATE/DELETE command */
|
|
char *orig_query; /* original text of INSERT command */
|
|
List *target_attrs; /* list of target attribute numbers */
|
|
int values_end; /* length up to the end of VALUES */
|
|
int batch_size; /* value of FDW option "batch_size" */
|
|
bool has_returning; /* is there a RETURNING clause? */
|
|
List *retrieved_attrs; /* attr numbers retrieved by RETURNING */
|
|
|
|
/* info about parameters for prepared statement */
|
|
AttrNumber ctidAttno; /* attnum of input resjunk ctid column */
|
|
int p_nums; /* number of parameters to transmit */
|
|
FmgrInfo *p_flinfo; /* output conversion functions for them */
|
|
|
|
/* batch operation stuff */
|
|
int num_slots; /* number of slots to insert */
|
|
|
|
/* working memory context */
|
|
MemoryContext temp_cxt; /* context for per-tuple temporary data */
|
|
|
|
/* for update row movement if subplan result rel */
|
|
struct PgFdwModifyState *aux_fmstate; /* foreign-insert state, if
|
|
* created */
|
|
} PgFdwModifyState;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Execution state of a foreign scan that modifies a foreign table directly.
|
|
*/
|
|
typedef struct PgFdwDirectModifyState
|
|
{
|
|
Relation rel; /* relcache entry for the foreign table */
|
|
AttInMetadata *attinmeta; /* attribute datatype conversion metadata */
|
|
|
|
/* extracted fdw_private data */
|
|
char *query; /* text of UPDATE/DELETE command */
|
|
bool has_returning; /* is there a RETURNING clause? */
|
|
List *retrieved_attrs; /* attr numbers retrieved by RETURNING */
|
|
bool set_processed; /* do we set the command es_processed? */
|
|
|
|
/* for remote query execution */
|
|
PGconn *conn; /* connection for the update */
|
|
PgFdwConnState *conn_state; /* extra per-connection state */
|
|
int numParams; /* number of parameters passed to query */
|
|
FmgrInfo *param_flinfo; /* output conversion functions for them */
|
|
List *param_exprs; /* executable expressions for param values */
|
|
const char **param_values; /* textual values of query parameters */
|
|
|
|
/* for storing result tuples */
|
|
PGresult *result; /* result for query */
|
|
int num_tuples; /* # of result tuples */
|
|
int next_tuple; /* index of next one to return */
|
|
Relation resultRel; /* relcache entry for the target relation */
|
|
AttrNumber *attnoMap; /* array of attnums of input user columns */
|
|
AttrNumber ctidAttno; /* attnum of input ctid column */
|
|
AttrNumber oidAttno; /* attnum of input oid column */
|
|
bool hasSystemCols; /* are there system columns of resultRel? */
|
|
|
|
/* working memory context */
|
|
MemoryContext temp_cxt; /* context for per-tuple temporary data */
|
|
} PgFdwDirectModifyState;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Workspace for analyzing a foreign table.
|
|
*/
|
|
typedef struct PgFdwAnalyzeState
|
|
{
|
|
Relation rel; /* relcache entry for the foreign table */
|
|
AttInMetadata *attinmeta; /* attribute datatype conversion metadata */
|
|
List *retrieved_attrs; /* attr numbers retrieved by query */
|
|
|
|
/* collected sample rows */
|
|
HeapTuple *rows; /* array of size targrows */
|
|
int targrows; /* target # of sample rows */
|
|
int numrows; /* # of sample rows collected */
|
|
|
|
/* for random sampling */
|
|
double samplerows; /* # of rows fetched */
|
|
double rowstoskip; /* # of rows to skip before next sample */
|
|
ReservoirStateData rstate; /* state for reservoir sampling */
|
|
|
|
/* working memory contexts */
|
|
MemoryContext anl_cxt; /* context for per-analyze lifespan data */
|
|
MemoryContext temp_cxt; /* context for per-tuple temporary data */
|
|
} PgFdwAnalyzeState;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* This enum describes what's kept in the fdw_private list for a ForeignPath.
|
|
* We store:
|
|
*
|
|
* 1) Boolean flag showing if the remote query has the final sort
|
|
* 2) Boolean flag showing if the remote query has the LIMIT clause
|
|
*/
|
|
enum FdwPathPrivateIndex
|
|
{
|
|
/* has-final-sort flag (as a Boolean node) */
|
|
FdwPathPrivateHasFinalSort,
|
|
/* has-limit flag (as a Boolean node) */
|
|
FdwPathPrivateHasLimit
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Struct for extra information passed to estimate_path_cost_size() */
|
|
typedef struct
|
|
{
|
|
PathTarget *target;
|
|
bool has_final_sort;
|
|
bool has_limit;
|
|
double limit_tuples;
|
|
int64 count_est;
|
|
int64 offset_est;
|
|
} PgFdwPathExtraData;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Identify the attribute where data conversion fails.
|
|
*/
|
|
typedef struct ConversionLocation
|
|
{
|
|
AttrNumber cur_attno; /* attribute number being processed, or 0 */
|
|
Relation rel; /* foreign table being processed, or NULL */
|
|
ForeignScanState *fsstate; /* plan node being processed, or NULL */
|
|
} ConversionLocation;
|
|
|
|
/* Callback argument for ec_member_matches_foreign */
|
|
typedef struct
|
|
{
|
|
Expr *current; /* current expr, or NULL if not yet found */
|
|
List *already_used; /* expressions already dealt with */
|
|
} ec_member_foreign_arg;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* SQL functions
|
|
*/
|
|
PG_FUNCTION_INFO_V1(postgres_fdw_handler);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* FDW callback routines
|
|
*/
|
|
static void postgresGetForeignRelSize(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
RelOptInfo *baserel,
|
|
Oid foreigntableid);
|
|
static void postgresGetForeignPaths(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
RelOptInfo *baserel,
|
|
Oid foreigntableid);
|
|
static ForeignScan *postgresGetForeignPlan(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
RelOptInfo *foreignrel,
|
|
Oid foreigntableid,
|
|
ForeignPath *best_path,
|
|
List *tlist,
|
|
List *scan_clauses,
|
|
Plan *outer_plan);
|
|
static void postgresBeginForeignScan(ForeignScanState *node, int eflags);
|
|
static TupleTableSlot *postgresIterateForeignScan(ForeignScanState *node);
|
|
static void postgresReScanForeignScan(ForeignScanState *node);
|
|
static void postgresEndForeignScan(ForeignScanState *node);
|
|
static void postgresAddForeignUpdateTargets(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
Index rtindex,
|
|
RangeTblEntry *target_rte,
|
|
Relation target_relation);
|
|
static List *postgresPlanForeignModify(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
ModifyTable *plan,
|
|
Index resultRelation,
|
|
int subplan_index);
|
|
static void postgresBeginForeignModify(ModifyTableState *mtstate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo,
|
|
List *fdw_private,
|
|
int subplan_index,
|
|
int eflags);
|
|
static TupleTableSlot *postgresExecForeignInsert(EState *estate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo,
|
|
TupleTableSlot *slot,
|
|
TupleTableSlot *planSlot);
|
|
static TupleTableSlot **postgresExecForeignBatchInsert(EState *estate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo,
|
|
TupleTableSlot **slots,
|
|
TupleTableSlot **planSlots,
|
|
int *numSlots);
|
|
static int postgresGetForeignModifyBatchSize(ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo);
|
|
static TupleTableSlot *postgresExecForeignUpdate(EState *estate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo,
|
|
TupleTableSlot *slot,
|
|
TupleTableSlot *planSlot);
|
|
static TupleTableSlot *postgresExecForeignDelete(EState *estate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo,
|
|
TupleTableSlot *slot,
|
|
TupleTableSlot *planSlot);
|
|
static void postgresEndForeignModify(EState *estate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo);
|
|
static void postgresBeginForeignInsert(ModifyTableState *mtstate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo);
|
|
static void postgresEndForeignInsert(EState *estate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo);
|
|
static int postgresIsForeignRelUpdatable(Relation rel);
|
|
static bool postgresPlanDirectModify(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
ModifyTable *plan,
|
|
Index resultRelation,
|
|
int subplan_index);
|
|
static void postgresBeginDirectModify(ForeignScanState *node, int eflags);
|
|
static TupleTableSlot *postgresIterateDirectModify(ForeignScanState *node);
|
|
static void postgresEndDirectModify(ForeignScanState *node);
|
|
static void postgresExplainForeignScan(ForeignScanState *node,
|
|
ExplainState *es);
|
|
static void postgresExplainForeignModify(ModifyTableState *mtstate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *rinfo,
|
|
List *fdw_private,
|
|
int subplan_index,
|
|
ExplainState *es);
|
|
static void postgresExplainDirectModify(ForeignScanState *node,
|
|
ExplainState *es);
|
|
static void postgresExecForeignTruncate(List *rels,
|
|
DropBehavior behavior,
|
|
bool restart_seqs);
|
|
static bool postgresAnalyzeForeignTable(Relation relation,
|
|
AcquireSampleRowsFunc *func,
|
|
BlockNumber *totalpages);
|
|
static List *postgresImportForeignSchema(ImportForeignSchemaStmt *stmt,
|
|
Oid serverOid);
|
|
static void postgresGetForeignJoinPaths(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
RelOptInfo *joinrel,
|
|
RelOptInfo *outerrel,
|
|
RelOptInfo *innerrel,
|
|
JoinType jointype,
|
|
JoinPathExtraData *extra);
|
|
static bool postgresRecheckForeignScan(ForeignScanState *node,
|
|
TupleTableSlot *slot);
|
|
static void postgresGetForeignUpperPaths(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
UpperRelationKind stage,
|
|
RelOptInfo *input_rel,
|
|
RelOptInfo *output_rel,
|
|
void *extra);
|
|
static bool postgresIsForeignPathAsyncCapable(ForeignPath *path);
|
|
static void postgresForeignAsyncRequest(AsyncRequest *areq);
|
|
static void postgresForeignAsyncConfigureWait(AsyncRequest *areq);
|
|
static void postgresForeignAsyncNotify(AsyncRequest *areq);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Helper functions
|
|
*/
|
|
static void estimate_path_cost_size(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
RelOptInfo *foreignrel,
|
|
List *param_join_conds,
|
|
List *pathkeys,
|
|
PgFdwPathExtraData *fpextra,
|
|
double *p_rows, int *p_width,
|
|
Cost *p_startup_cost, Cost *p_total_cost);
|
|
static void get_remote_estimate(const char *sql,
|
|
PGconn *conn,
|
|
double *rows,
|
|
int *width,
|
|
Cost *startup_cost,
|
|
Cost *total_cost);
|
|
static void adjust_foreign_grouping_path_cost(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
List *pathkeys,
|
|
double retrieved_rows,
|
|
double width,
|
|
double limit_tuples,
|
|
Cost *p_startup_cost,
|
|
Cost *p_run_cost);
|
|
static bool ec_member_matches_foreign(PlannerInfo *root, RelOptInfo *rel,
|
|
EquivalenceClass *ec, EquivalenceMember *em,
|
|
void *arg);
|
|
static void create_cursor(ForeignScanState *node);
|
|
static void fetch_more_data(ForeignScanState *node);
|
|
static void close_cursor(PGconn *conn, unsigned int cursor_number,
|
|
PgFdwConnState *conn_state);
|
|
static PgFdwModifyState *create_foreign_modify(EState *estate,
|
|
RangeTblEntry *rte,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo,
|
|
CmdType operation,
|
|
Plan *subplan,
|
|
char *query,
|
|
List *target_attrs,
|
|
int len,
|
|
bool has_returning,
|
|
List *retrieved_attrs);
|
|
static TupleTableSlot **execute_foreign_modify(EState *estate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo,
|
|
CmdType operation,
|
|
TupleTableSlot **slots,
|
|
TupleTableSlot **planSlots,
|
|
int *numSlots);
|
|
static void prepare_foreign_modify(PgFdwModifyState *fmstate);
|
|
static const char **convert_prep_stmt_params(PgFdwModifyState *fmstate,
|
|
ItemPointer tupleid,
|
|
TupleTableSlot **slots,
|
|
int numSlots);
|
|
static void store_returning_result(PgFdwModifyState *fmstate,
|
|
TupleTableSlot *slot, PGresult *res);
|
|
static void finish_foreign_modify(PgFdwModifyState *fmstate);
|
|
static void deallocate_query(PgFdwModifyState *fmstate);
|
|
static List *build_remote_returning(Index rtindex, Relation rel,
|
|
List *returningList);
|
|
static void rebuild_fdw_scan_tlist(ForeignScan *fscan, List *tlist);
|
|
static void execute_dml_stmt(ForeignScanState *node);
|
|
static TupleTableSlot *get_returning_data(ForeignScanState *node);
|
|
static void init_returning_filter(PgFdwDirectModifyState *dmstate,
|
|
List *fdw_scan_tlist,
|
|
Index rtindex);
|
|
static TupleTableSlot *apply_returning_filter(PgFdwDirectModifyState *dmstate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo,
|
|
TupleTableSlot *slot,
|
|
EState *estate);
|
|
static void prepare_query_params(PlanState *node,
|
|
List *fdw_exprs,
|
|
int numParams,
|
|
FmgrInfo **param_flinfo,
|
|
List **param_exprs,
|
|
const char ***param_values);
|
|
static void process_query_params(ExprContext *econtext,
|
|
FmgrInfo *param_flinfo,
|
|
List *param_exprs,
|
|
const char **param_values);
|
|
static int postgresAcquireSampleRowsFunc(Relation relation, int elevel,
|
|
HeapTuple *rows, int targrows,
|
|
double *totalrows,
|
|
double *totaldeadrows);
|
|
static void analyze_row_processor(PGresult *res, int row,
|
|
PgFdwAnalyzeState *astate);
|
|
static void produce_tuple_asynchronously(AsyncRequest *areq, bool fetch);
|
|
static void fetch_more_data_begin(AsyncRequest *areq);
|
|
static void complete_pending_request(AsyncRequest *areq);
|
|
static HeapTuple make_tuple_from_result_row(PGresult *res,
|
|
int row,
|
|
Relation rel,
|
|
AttInMetadata *attinmeta,
|
|
List *retrieved_attrs,
|
|
ForeignScanState *fsstate,
|
|
MemoryContext temp_context);
|
|
static void conversion_error_callback(void *arg);
|
|
static bool foreign_join_ok(PlannerInfo *root, RelOptInfo *joinrel,
|
|
JoinType jointype, RelOptInfo *outerrel, RelOptInfo *innerrel,
|
|
JoinPathExtraData *extra);
|
|
static bool foreign_grouping_ok(PlannerInfo *root, RelOptInfo *grouped_rel,
|
|
Node *havingQual);
|
|
static List *get_useful_pathkeys_for_relation(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
RelOptInfo *rel);
|
|
static List *get_useful_ecs_for_relation(PlannerInfo *root, RelOptInfo *rel);
|
|
static void add_paths_with_pathkeys_for_rel(PlannerInfo *root, RelOptInfo *rel,
|
|
Path *epq_path);
|
|
static void add_foreign_grouping_paths(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
RelOptInfo *input_rel,
|
|
RelOptInfo *grouped_rel,
|
|
GroupPathExtraData *extra);
|
|
static void add_foreign_ordered_paths(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
RelOptInfo *input_rel,
|
|
RelOptInfo *ordered_rel);
|
|
static void add_foreign_final_paths(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
RelOptInfo *input_rel,
|
|
RelOptInfo *final_rel,
|
|
FinalPathExtraData *extra);
|
|
static void apply_server_options(PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo);
|
|
static void apply_table_options(PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo);
|
|
static void merge_fdw_options(PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo,
|
|
const PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo_o,
|
|
const PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo_i);
|
|
static int get_batch_size_option(Relation rel);
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Foreign-data wrapper handler function: return a struct with pointers
|
|
* to my callback routines.
|
|
*/
|
|
Datum
|
|
postgres_fdw_handler(PG_FUNCTION_ARGS)
|
|
{
|
|
FdwRoutine *routine = makeNode(FdwRoutine);
|
|
|
|
/* Functions for scanning foreign tables */
|
|
routine->GetForeignRelSize = postgresGetForeignRelSize;
|
|
routine->GetForeignPaths = postgresGetForeignPaths;
|
|
routine->GetForeignPlan = postgresGetForeignPlan;
|
|
routine->BeginForeignScan = postgresBeginForeignScan;
|
|
routine->IterateForeignScan = postgresIterateForeignScan;
|
|
routine->ReScanForeignScan = postgresReScanForeignScan;
|
|
routine->EndForeignScan = postgresEndForeignScan;
|
|
|
|
/* Functions for updating foreign tables */
|
|
routine->AddForeignUpdateTargets = postgresAddForeignUpdateTargets;
|
|
routine->PlanForeignModify = postgresPlanForeignModify;
|
|
routine->BeginForeignModify = postgresBeginForeignModify;
|
|
routine->ExecForeignInsert = postgresExecForeignInsert;
|
|
routine->ExecForeignBatchInsert = postgresExecForeignBatchInsert;
|
|
routine->GetForeignModifyBatchSize = postgresGetForeignModifyBatchSize;
|
|
routine->ExecForeignUpdate = postgresExecForeignUpdate;
|
|
routine->ExecForeignDelete = postgresExecForeignDelete;
|
|
routine->EndForeignModify = postgresEndForeignModify;
|
|
routine->BeginForeignInsert = postgresBeginForeignInsert;
|
|
routine->EndForeignInsert = postgresEndForeignInsert;
|
|
routine->IsForeignRelUpdatable = postgresIsForeignRelUpdatable;
|
|
routine->PlanDirectModify = postgresPlanDirectModify;
|
|
routine->BeginDirectModify = postgresBeginDirectModify;
|
|
routine->IterateDirectModify = postgresIterateDirectModify;
|
|
routine->EndDirectModify = postgresEndDirectModify;
|
|
|
|
/* Function for EvalPlanQual rechecks */
|
|
routine->RecheckForeignScan = postgresRecheckForeignScan;
|
|
/* Support functions for EXPLAIN */
|
|
routine->ExplainForeignScan = postgresExplainForeignScan;
|
|
routine->ExplainForeignModify = postgresExplainForeignModify;
|
|
routine->ExplainDirectModify = postgresExplainDirectModify;
|
|
|
|
/* Support function for TRUNCATE */
|
|
routine->ExecForeignTruncate = postgresExecForeignTruncate;
|
|
|
|
/* Support functions for ANALYZE */
|
|
routine->AnalyzeForeignTable = postgresAnalyzeForeignTable;
|
|
|
|
/* Support functions for IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA */
|
|
routine->ImportForeignSchema = postgresImportForeignSchema;
|
|
|
|
/* Support functions for join push-down */
|
|
routine->GetForeignJoinPaths = postgresGetForeignJoinPaths;
|
|
|
|
/* Support functions for upper relation push-down */
|
|
routine->GetForeignUpperPaths = postgresGetForeignUpperPaths;
|
|
|
|
/* Support functions for asynchronous execution */
|
|
routine->IsForeignPathAsyncCapable = postgresIsForeignPathAsyncCapable;
|
|
routine->ForeignAsyncRequest = postgresForeignAsyncRequest;
|
|
routine->ForeignAsyncConfigureWait = postgresForeignAsyncConfigureWait;
|
|
routine->ForeignAsyncNotify = postgresForeignAsyncNotify;
|
|
|
|
PG_RETURN_POINTER(routine);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresGetForeignRelSize
|
|
* Estimate # of rows and width of the result of the scan
|
|
*
|
|
* We should consider the effect of all baserestrictinfo clauses here, but
|
|
* not any join clauses.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
postgresGetForeignRelSize(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
RelOptInfo *baserel,
|
|
Oid foreigntableid)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo;
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
RangeTblEntry *rte = planner_rt_fetch(baserel->relid, root);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* We use PgFdwRelationInfo to pass various information to subsequent
|
|
* functions.
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo = (PgFdwRelationInfo *) palloc0(sizeof(PgFdwRelationInfo));
|
|
baserel->fdw_private = (void *) fpinfo;
|
|
|
|
/* Base foreign tables need to be pushed down always. */
|
|
fpinfo->pushdown_safe = true;
|
|
|
|
/* Look up foreign-table catalog info. */
|
|
fpinfo->table = GetForeignTable(foreigntableid);
|
|
fpinfo->server = GetForeignServer(fpinfo->table->serverid);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Extract user-settable option values. Note that per-table settings of
|
|
* use_remote_estimate, fetch_size and async_capable override per-server
|
|
* settings of them, respectively.
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo->use_remote_estimate = false;
|
|
fpinfo->fdw_startup_cost = DEFAULT_FDW_STARTUP_COST;
|
|
fpinfo->fdw_tuple_cost = DEFAULT_FDW_TUPLE_COST;
|
|
fpinfo->shippable_extensions = NIL;
|
|
fpinfo->fetch_size = 100;
|
|
fpinfo->async_capable = false;
|
|
|
|
apply_server_options(fpinfo);
|
|
apply_table_options(fpinfo);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If the table or the server is configured to use remote estimates,
|
|
* identify which user to do remote access as during planning. This
|
|
* should match what ExecCheckRTEPerms() does. If we fail due to lack of
|
|
* permissions, the query would have failed at runtime anyway.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fpinfo->use_remote_estimate)
|
|
{
|
|
Oid userid = rte->checkAsUser ? rte->checkAsUser : GetUserId();
|
|
|
|
fpinfo->user = GetUserMapping(userid, fpinfo->server->serverid);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
fpinfo->user = NULL;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Identify which baserestrictinfo clauses can be sent to the remote
|
|
* server and which can't.
|
|
*/
|
|
classifyConditions(root, baserel, baserel->baserestrictinfo,
|
|
&fpinfo->remote_conds, &fpinfo->local_conds);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Identify which attributes will need to be retrieved from the remote
|
|
* server. These include all attrs needed for joins or final output, plus
|
|
* all attrs used in the local_conds. (Note: if we end up using a
|
|
* parameterized scan, it's possible that some of the join clauses will be
|
|
* sent to the remote and thus we wouldn't really need to retrieve the
|
|
* columns used in them. Doesn't seem worth detecting that case though.)
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo->attrs_used = NULL;
|
|
pull_varattnos((Node *) baserel->reltarget->exprs, baserel->relid,
|
|
&fpinfo->attrs_used);
|
|
foreach(lc, fpinfo->local_conds)
|
|
{
|
|
RestrictInfo *rinfo = lfirst_node(RestrictInfo, lc);
|
|
|
|
pull_varattnos((Node *) rinfo->clause, baserel->relid,
|
|
&fpinfo->attrs_used);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Compute the selectivity and cost of the local_conds, so we don't have
|
|
* to do it over again for each path. The best we can do for these
|
|
* conditions is to estimate selectivity on the basis of local statistics.
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo->local_conds_sel = clauselist_selectivity(root,
|
|
fpinfo->local_conds,
|
|
baserel->relid,
|
|
JOIN_INNER,
|
|
NULL);
|
|
|
|
cost_qual_eval(&fpinfo->local_conds_cost, fpinfo->local_conds, root);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Set # of retrieved rows and cached relation costs to some negative
|
|
* value, so that we can detect when they are set to some sensible values,
|
|
* during one (usually the first) of the calls to estimate_path_cost_size.
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo->retrieved_rows = -1;
|
|
fpinfo->rel_startup_cost = -1;
|
|
fpinfo->rel_total_cost = -1;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If the table or the server is configured to use remote estimates,
|
|
* connect to the foreign server and execute EXPLAIN to estimate the
|
|
* number of rows selected by the restriction clauses, as well as the
|
|
* average row width. Otherwise, estimate using whatever statistics we
|
|
* have locally, in a way similar to ordinary tables.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fpinfo->use_remote_estimate)
|
|
{
|
|
/*
|
|
* Get cost/size estimates with help of remote server. Save the
|
|
* values in fpinfo so we don't need to do it again to generate the
|
|
* basic foreign path.
|
|
*/
|
|
estimate_path_cost_size(root, baserel, NIL, NIL, NULL,
|
|
&fpinfo->rows, &fpinfo->width,
|
|
&fpinfo->startup_cost, &fpinfo->total_cost);
|
|
|
|
/* Report estimated baserel size to planner. */
|
|
baserel->rows = fpinfo->rows;
|
|
baserel->reltarget->width = fpinfo->width;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/*
|
|
* If the foreign table has never been ANALYZEd, it will have
|
|
* reltuples < 0, meaning "unknown". We can't do much if we're not
|
|
* allowed to consult the remote server, but we can use a hack similar
|
|
* to plancat.c's treatment of empty relations: use a minimum size
|
|
* estimate of 10 pages, and divide by the column-datatype-based width
|
|
* estimate to get the corresponding number of tuples.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (baserel->tuples < 0)
|
|
{
|
|
baserel->pages = 10;
|
|
baserel->tuples =
|
|
(10 * BLCKSZ) / (baserel->reltarget->width +
|
|
MAXALIGN(SizeofHeapTupleHeader));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Estimate baserel size as best we can with local statistics. */
|
|
set_baserel_size_estimates(root, baserel);
|
|
|
|
/* Fill in basically-bogus cost estimates for use later. */
|
|
estimate_path_cost_size(root, baserel, NIL, NIL, NULL,
|
|
&fpinfo->rows, &fpinfo->width,
|
|
&fpinfo->startup_cost, &fpinfo->total_cost);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* fpinfo->relation_name gets the numeric rangetable index of the foreign
|
|
* table RTE. (If this query gets EXPLAIN'd, we'll convert that to a
|
|
* human-readable string at that time.)
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo->relation_name = psprintf("%u", baserel->relid);
|
|
|
|
/* No outer and inner relations. */
|
|
fpinfo->make_outerrel_subquery = false;
|
|
fpinfo->make_innerrel_subquery = false;
|
|
fpinfo->lower_subquery_rels = NULL;
|
|
/* Set the relation index. */
|
|
fpinfo->relation_index = baserel->relid;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* get_useful_ecs_for_relation
|
|
* Determine which EquivalenceClasses might be involved in useful
|
|
* orderings of this relation.
|
|
*
|
|
* This function is in some respects a mirror image of the core function
|
|
* pathkeys_useful_for_merging: for a regular table, we know what indexes
|
|
* we have and want to test whether any of them are useful. For a foreign
|
|
* table, we don't know what indexes are present on the remote side but
|
|
* want to speculate about which ones we'd like to use if they existed.
|
|
*
|
|
* This function returns a list of potentially-useful equivalence classes,
|
|
* but it does not guarantee that an EquivalenceMember exists which contains
|
|
* Vars only from the given relation. For example, given ft1 JOIN t1 ON
|
|
* ft1.x + t1.x = 0, this function will say that the equivalence class
|
|
* containing ft1.x + t1.x is potentially useful. Supposing ft1 is remote and
|
|
* t1 is local (or on a different server), it will turn out that no useful
|
|
* ORDER BY clause can be generated. It's not our job to figure that out
|
|
* here; we're only interested in identifying relevant ECs.
|
|
*/
|
|
static List *
|
|
get_useful_ecs_for_relation(PlannerInfo *root, RelOptInfo *rel)
|
|
{
|
|
List *useful_eclass_list = NIL;
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
Relids relids;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* First, consider whether any active EC is potentially useful for a merge
|
|
* join against this relation.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (rel->has_eclass_joins)
|
|
{
|
|
foreach(lc, root->eq_classes)
|
|
{
|
|
EquivalenceClass *cur_ec = (EquivalenceClass *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
|
|
if (eclass_useful_for_merging(root, cur_ec, rel))
|
|
useful_eclass_list = lappend(useful_eclass_list, cur_ec);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Next, consider whether there are any non-EC derivable join clauses that
|
|
* are merge-joinable. If the joininfo list is empty, we can exit
|
|
* quickly.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (rel->joininfo == NIL)
|
|
return useful_eclass_list;
|
|
|
|
/* If this is a child rel, we must use the topmost parent rel to search. */
|
|
if (IS_OTHER_REL(rel))
|
|
{
|
|
Assert(!bms_is_empty(rel->top_parent_relids));
|
|
relids = rel->top_parent_relids;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
relids = rel->relids;
|
|
|
|
/* Check each join clause in turn. */
|
|
foreach(lc, rel->joininfo)
|
|
{
|
|
RestrictInfo *restrictinfo = (RestrictInfo *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
|
|
/* Consider only mergejoinable clauses */
|
|
if (restrictinfo->mergeopfamilies == NIL)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Make sure we've got canonical ECs. */
|
|
update_mergeclause_eclasses(root, restrictinfo);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* restrictinfo->mergeopfamilies != NIL is sufficient to guarantee
|
|
* that left_ec and right_ec will be initialized, per comments in
|
|
* distribute_qual_to_rels.
|
|
*
|
|
* We want to identify which side of this merge-joinable clause
|
|
* contains columns from the relation produced by this RelOptInfo. We
|
|
* test for overlap, not containment, because there could be extra
|
|
* relations on either side. For example, suppose we've got something
|
|
* like ((A JOIN B ON A.x = B.x) JOIN C ON A.y = C.y) LEFT JOIN D ON
|
|
* A.y = D.y. The input rel might be the joinrel between A and B, and
|
|
* we'll consider the join clause A.y = D.y. relids contains a
|
|
* relation not involved in the join class (B) and the equivalence
|
|
* class for the left-hand side of the clause contains a relation not
|
|
* involved in the input rel (C). Despite the fact that we have only
|
|
* overlap and not containment in either direction, A.y is potentially
|
|
* useful as a sort column.
|
|
*
|
|
* Note that it's even possible that relids overlaps neither side of
|
|
* the join clause. For example, consider A LEFT JOIN B ON A.x = B.x
|
|
* AND A.x = 1. The clause A.x = 1 will appear in B's joininfo list,
|
|
* but overlaps neither side of B. In that case, we just skip this
|
|
* join clause, since it doesn't suggest a useful sort order for this
|
|
* relation.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (bms_overlap(relids, restrictinfo->right_ec->ec_relids))
|
|
useful_eclass_list = list_append_unique_ptr(useful_eclass_list,
|
|
restrictinfo->right_ec);
|
|
else if (bms_overlap(relids, restrictinfo->left_ec->ec_relids))
|
|
useful_eclass_list = list_append_unique_ptr(useful_eclass_list,
|
|
restrictinfo->left_ec);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return useful_eclass_list;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* get_useful_pathkeys_for_relation
|
|
* Determine which orderings of a relation might be useful.
|
|
*
|
|
* Getting data in sorted order can be useful either because the requested
|
|
* order matches the final output ordering for the overall query we're
|
|
* planning, or because it enables an efficient merge join. Here, we try
|
|
* to figure out which pathkeys to consider.
|
|
*/
|
|
static List *
|
|
get_useful_pathkeys_for_relation(PlannerInfo *root, RelOptInfo *rel)
|
|
{
|
|
List *useful_pathkeys_list = NIL;
|
|
List *useful_eclass_list;
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo = (PgFdwRelationInfo *) rel->fdw_private;
|
|
EquivalenceClass *query_ec = NULL;
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Pushing the query_pathkeys to the remote server is always worth
|
|
* considering, because it might let us avoid a local sort.
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo->qp_is_pushdown_safe = false;
|
|
if (root->query_pathkeys)
|
|
{
|
|
bool query_pathkeys_ok = true;
|
|
|
|
foreach(lc, root->query_pathkeys)
|
|
{
|
|
PathKey *pathkey = (PathKey *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* The planner and executor don't have any clever strategy for
|
|
* taking data sorted by a prefix of the query's pathkeys and
|
|
* getting it to be sorted by all of those pathkeys. We'll just
|
|
* end up resorting the entire data set. So, unless we can push
|
|
* down all of the query pathkeys, forget it.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!is_foreign_pathkey(root, rel, pathkey))
|
|
{
|
|
query_pathkeys_ok = false;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (query_pathkeys_ok)
|
|
{
|
|
useful_pathkeys_list = list_make1(list_copy(root->query_pathkeys));
|
|
fpinfo->qp_is_pushdown_safe = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Even if we're not using remote estimates, having the remote side do the
|
|
* sort generally won't be any worse than doing it locally, and it might
|
|
* be much better if the remote side can generate data in the right order
|
|
* without needing a sort at all. However, what we're going to do next is
|
|
* try to generate pathkeys that seem promising for possible merge joins,
|
|
* and that's more speculative. A wrong choice might hurt quite a bit, so
|
|
* bail out if we can't use remote estimates.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!fpinfo->use_remote_estimate)
|
|
return useful_pathkeys_list;
|
|
|
|
/* Get the list of interesting EquivalenceClasses. */
|
|
useful_eclass_list = get_useful_ecs_for_relation(root, rel);
|
|
|
|
/* Extract unique EC for query, if any, so we don't consider it again. */
|
|
if (list_length(root->query_pathkeys) == 1)
|
|
{
|
|
PathKey *query_pathkey = linitial(root->query_pathkeys);
|
|
|
|
query_ec = query_pathkey->pk_eclass;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* As a heuristic, the only pathkeys we consider here are those of length
|
|
* one. It's surely possible to consider more, but since each one we
|
|
* choose to consider will generate a round-trip to the remote side, we
|
|
* need to be a bit cautious here. It would sure be nice to have a local
|
|
* cache of information about remote index definitions...
|
|
*/
|
|
foreach(lc, useful_eclass_list)
|
|
{
|
|
EquivalenceClass *cur_ec = lfirst(lc);
|
|
PathKey *pathkey;
|
|
|
|
/* If redundant with what we did above, skip it. */
|
|
if (cur_ec == query_ec)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Can't push down the sort if the EC's opfamily is not shippable. */
|
|
if (!is_shippable(linitial_oid(cur_ec->ec_opfamilies),
|
|
OperatorFamilyRelationId, fpinfo))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* If no pushable expression for this rel, skip it. */
|
|
if (find_em_for_rel(root, cur_ec, rel) == NULL)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Looks like we can generate a pathkey, so let's do it. */
|
|
pathkey = make_canonical_pathkey(root, cur_ec,
|
|
linitial_oid(cur_ec->ec_opfamilies),
|
|
BTLessStrategyNumber,
|
|
false);
|
|
useful_pathkeys_list = lappend(useful_pathkeys_list,
|
|
list_make1(pathkey));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return useful_pathkeys_list;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresGetForeignPaths
|
|
* Create possible scan paths for a scan on the foreign table
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
postgresGetForeignPaths(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
RelOptInfo *baserel,
|
|
Oid foreigntableid)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo = (PgFdwRelationInfo *) baserel->fdw_private;
|
|
ForeignPath *path;
|
|
List *ppi_list;
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Create simplest ForeignScan path node and add it to baserel. This path
|
|
* corresponds to SeqScan path of regular tables (though depending on what
|
|
* baserestrict conditions we were able to send to remote, there might
|
|
* actually be an indexscan happening there). We already did all the work
|
|
* to estimate cost and size of this path.
|
|
*
|
|
* Although this path uses no join clauses, it could still have required
|
|
* parameterization due to LATERAL refs in its tlist.
|
|
*/
|
|
path = create_foreignscan_path(root, baserel,
|
|
NULL, /* default pathtarget */
|
|
fpinfo->rows,
|
|
fpinfo->startup_cost,
|
|
fpinfo->total_cost,
|
|
NIL, /* no pathkeys */
|
|
baserel->lateral_relids,
|
|
NULL, /* no extra plan */
|
|
NIL); /* no fdw_private list */
|
|
add_path(baserel, (Path *) path);
|
|
|
|
/* Add paths with pathkeys */
|
|
add_paths_with_pathkeys_for_rel(root, baserel, NULL);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If we're not using remote estimates, stop here. We have no way to
|
|
* estimate whether any join clauses would be worth sending across, so
|
|
* don't bother building parameterized paths.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!fpinfo->use_remote_estimate)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Thumb through all join clauses for the rel to identify which outer
|
|
* relations could supply one or more safe-to-send-to-remote join clauses.
|
|
* We'll build a parameterized path for each such outer relation.
|
|
*
|
|
* It's convenient to manage this by representing each candidate outer
|
|
* relation by the ParamPathInfo node for it. We can then use the
|
|
* ppi_clauses list in the ParamPathInfo node directly as a list of the
|
|
* interesting join clauses for that rel. This takes care of the
|
|
* possibility that there are multiple safe join clauses for such a rel,
|
|
* and also ensures that we account for unsafe join clauses that we'll
|
|
* still have to enforce locally (since the parameterized-path machinery
|
|
* insists that we handle all movable clauses).
|
|
*/
|
|
ppi_list = NIL;
|
|
foreach(lc, baserel->joininfo)
|
|
{
|
|
RestrictInfo *rinfo = (RestrictInfo *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
Relids required_outer;
|
|
ParamPathInfo *param_info;
|
|
|
|
/* Check if clause can be moved to this rel */
|
|
if (!join_clause_is_movable_to(rinfo, baserel))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* See if it is safe to send to remote */
|
|
if (!is_foreign_expr(root, baserel, rinfo->clause))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Calculate required outer rels for the resulting path */
|
|
required_outer = bms_union(rinfo->clause_relids,
|
|
baserel->lateral_relids);
|
|
/* We do not want the foreign rel itself listed in required_outer */
|
|
required_outer = bms_del_member(required_outer, baserel->relid);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* required_outer probably can't be empty here, but if it were, we
|
|
* couldn't make a parameterized path.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (bms_is_empty(required_outer))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Get the ParamPathInfo */
|
|
param_info = get_baserel_parampathinfo(root, baserel,
|
|
required_outer);
|
|
Assert(param_info != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Add it to list unless we already have it. Testing pointer equality
|
|
* is OK since get_baserel_parampathinfo won't make duplicates.
|
|
*/
|
|
ppi_list = list_append_unique_ptr(ppi_list, param_info);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* The above scan examined only "generic" join clauses, not those that
|
|
* were absorbed into EquivalenceClauses. See if we can make anything out
|
|
* of EquivalenceClauses.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (baserel->has_eclass_joins)
|
|
{
|
|
/*
|
|
* We repeatedly scan the eclass list looking for column references
|
|
* (or expressions) belonging to the foreign rel. Each time we find
|
|
* one, we generate a list of equivalence joinclauses for it, and then
|
|
* see if any are safe to send to the remote. Repeat till there are
|
|
* no more candidate EC members.
|
|
*/
|
|
ec_member_foreign_arg arg;
|
|
|
|
arg.already_used = NIL;
|
|
for (;;)
|
|
{
|
|
List *clauses;
|
|
|
|
/* Make clauses, skipping any that join to lateral_referencers */
|
|
arg.current = NULL;
|
|
clauses = generate_implied_equalities_for_column(root,
|
|
baserel,
|
|
ec_member_matches_foreign,
|
|
(void *) &arg,
|
|
baserel->lateral_referencers);
|
|
|
|
/* Done if there are no more expressions in the foreign rel */
|
|
if (arg.current == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
Assert(clauses == NIL);
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Scan the extracted join clauses */
|
|
foreach(lc, clauses)
|
|
{
|
|
RestrictInfo *rinfo = (RestrictInfo *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
Relids required_outer;
|
|
ParamPathInfo *param_info;
|
|
|
|
/* Check if clause can be moved to this rel */
|
|
if (!join_clause_is_movable_to(rinfo, baserel))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* See if it is safe to send to remote */
|
|
if (!is_foreign_expr(root, baserel, rinfo->clause))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Calculate required outer rels for the resulting path */
|
|
required_outer = bms_union(rinfo->clause_relids,
|
|
baserel->lateral_relids);
|
|
required_outer = bms_del_member(required_outer, baserel->relid);
|
|
if (bms_is_empty(required_outer))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Get the ParamPathInfo */
|
|
param_info = get_baserel_parampathinfo(root, baserel,
|
|
required_outer);
|
|
Assert(param_info != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* Add it to list unless we already have it */
|
|
ppi_list = list_append_unique_ptr(ppi_list, param_info);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Try again, now ignoring the expression we found this time */
|
|
arg.already_used = lappend(arg.already_used, arg.current);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Now build a path for each useful outer relation.
|
|
*/
|
|
foreach(lc, ppi_list)
|
|
{
|
|
ParamPathInfo *param_info = (ParamPathInfo *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
double rows;
|
|
int width;
|
|
Cost startup_cost;
|
|
Cost total_cost;
|
|
|
|
/* Get a cost estimate from the remote */
|
|
estimate_path_cost_size(root, baserel,
|
|
param_info->ppi_clauses, NIL, NULL,
|
|
&rows, &width,
|
|
&startup_cost, &total_cost);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* ppi_rows currently won't get looked at by anything, but still we
|
|
* may as well ensure that it matches our idea of the rowcount.
|
|
*/
|
|
param_info->ppi_rows = rows;
|
|
|
|
/* Make the path */
|
|
path = create_foreignscan_path(root, baserel,
|
|
NULL, /* default pathtarget */
|
|
rows,
|
|
startup_cost,
|
|
total_cost,
|
|
NIL, /* no pathkeys */
|
|
param_info->ppi_req_outer,
|
|
NULL,
|
|
NIL); /* no fdw_private list */
|
|
add_path(baserel, (Path *) path);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresGetForeignPlan
|
|
* Create ForeignScan plan node which implements selected best path
|
|
*/
|
|
static ForeignScan *
|
|
postgresGetForeignPlan(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
RelOptInfo *foreignrel,
|
|
Oid foreigntableid,
|
|
ForeignPath *best_path,
|
|
List *tlist,
|
|
List *scan_clauses,
|
|
Plan *outer_plan)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo = (PgFdwRelationInfo *) foreignrel->fdw_private;
|
|
Index scan_relid;
|
|
List *fdw_private;
|
|
List *remote_exprs = NIL;
|
|
List *local_exprs = NIL;
|
|
List *params_list = NIL;
|
|
List *fdw_scan_tlist = NIL;
|
|
List *fdw_recheck_quals = NIL;
|
|
List *retrieved_attrs;
|
|
StringInfoData sql;
|
|
bool has_final_sort = false;
|
|
bool has_limit = false;
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Get FDW private data created by postgresGetForeignUpperPaths(), if any.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (best_path->fdw_private)
|
|
{
|
|
has_final_sort = boolVal(list_nth(best_path->fdw_private,
|
|
FdwPathPrivateHasFinalSort));
|
|
has_limit = boolVal(list_nth(best_path->fdw_private,
|
|
FdwPathPrivateHasLimit));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (IS_SIMPLE_REL(foreignrel))
|
|
{
|
|
/*
|
|
* For base relations, set scan_relid as the relid of the relation.
|
|
*/
|
|
scan_relid = foreignrel->relid;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* In a base-relation scan, we must apply the given scan_clauses.
|
|
*
|
|
* Separate the scan_clauses into those that can be executed remotely
|
|
* and those that can't. baserestrictinfo clauses that were
|
|
* previously determined to be safe or unsafe by classifyConditions
|
|
* are found in fpinfo->remote_conds and fpinfo->local_conds. Anything
|
|
* else in the scan_clauses list will be a join clause, which we have
|
|
* to check for remote-safety.
|
|
*
|
|
* Note: the join clauses we see here should be the exact same ones
|
|
* previously examined by postgresGetForeignPaths. Possibly it'd be
|
|
* worth passing forward the classification work done then, rather
|
|
* than repeating it here.
|
|
*
|
|
* This code must match "extract_actual_clauses(scan_clauses, false)"
|
|
* except for the additional decision about remote versus local
|
|
* execution.
|
|
*/
|
|
foreach(lc, scan_clauses)
|
|
{
|
|
RestrictInfo *rinfo = lfirst_node(RestrictInfo, lc);
|
|
|
|
/* Ignore any pseudoconstants, they're dealt with elsewhere */
|
|
if (rinfo->pseudoconstant)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (list_member_ptr(fpinfo->remote_conds, rinfo))
|
|
remote_exprs = lappend(remote_exprs, rinfo->clause);
|
|
else if (list_member_ptr(fpinfo->local_conds, rinfo))
|
|
local_exprs = lappend(local_exprs, rinfo->clause);
|
|
else if (is_foreign_expr(root, foreignrel, rinfo->clause))
|
|
remote_exprs = lappend(remote_exprs, rinfo->clause);
|
|
else
|
|
local_exprs = lappend(local_exprs, rinfo->clause);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* For a base-relation scan, we have to support EPQ recheck, which
|
|
* should recheck all the remote quals.
|
|
*/
|
|
fdw_recheck_quals = remote_exprs;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/*
|
|
* Join relation or upper relation - set scan_relid to 0.
|
|
*/
|
|
scan_relid = 0;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* For a join rel, baserestrictinfo is NIL and we are not considering
|
|
* parameterization right now, so there should be no scan_clauses for
|
|
* a joinrel or an upper rel either.
|
|
*/
|
|
Assert(!scan_clauses);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Instead we get the conditions to apply from the fdw_private
|
|
* structure.
|
|
*/
|
|
remote_exprs = extract_actual_clauses(fpinfo->remote_conds, false);
|
|
local_exprs = extract_actual_clauses(fpinfo->local_conds, false);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* We leave fdw_recheck_quals empty in this case, since we never need
|
|
* to apply EPQ recheck clauses. In the case of a joinrel, EPQ
|
|
* recheck is handled elsewhere --- see postgresGetForeignJoinPaths().
|
|
* If we're planning an upperrel (ie, remote grouping or aggregation)
|
|
* then there's no EPQ to do because SELECT FOR UPDATE wouldn't be
|
|
* allowed, and indeed we *can't* put the remote clauses into
|
|
* fdw_recheck_quals because the unaggregated Vars won't be available
|
|
* locally.
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
/* Build the list of columns to be fetched from the foreign server. */
|
|
fdw_scan_tlist = build_tlist_to_deparse(foreignrel);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Ensure that the outer plan produces a tuple whose descriptor
|
|
* matches our scan tuple slot. Also, remove the local conditions
|
|
* from outer plan's quals, lest they be evaluated twice, once by the
|
|
* local plan and once by the scan.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (outer_plan)
|
|
{
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Right now, we only consider grouping and aggregation beyond
|
|
* joins. Queries involving aggregates or grouping do not require
|
|
* EPQ mechanism, hence should not have an outer plan here.
|
|
*/
|
|
Assert(!IS_UPPER_REL(foreignrel));
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* First, update the plan's qual list if possible. In some cases
|
|
* the quals might be enforced below the topmost plan level, in
|
|
* which case we'll fail to remove them; it's not worth working
|
|
* harder than this.
|
|
*/
|
|
foreach(lc, local_exprs)
|
|
{
|
|
Node *qual = lfirst(lc);
|
|
|
|
outer_plan->qual = list_delete(outer_plan->qual, qual);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* For an inner join the local conditions of foreign scan plan
|
|
* can be part of the joinquals as well. (They might also be
|
|
* in the mergequals or hashquals, but we can't touch those
|
|
* without breaking the plan.)
|
|
*/
|
|
if (IsA(outer_plan, NestLoop) ||
|
|
IsA(outer_plan, MergeJoin) ||
|
|
IsA(outer_plan, HashJoin))
|
|
{
|
|
Join *join_plan = (Join *) outer_plan;
|
|
|
|
if (join_plan->jointype == JOIN_INNER)
|
|
join_plan->joinqual = list_delete(join_plan->joinqual,
|
|
qual);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Now fix the subplan's tlist --- this might result in inserting
|
|
* a Result node atop the plan tree.
|
|
*/
|
|
outer_plan = change_plan_targetlist(outer_plan, fdw_scan_tlist,
|
|
best_path->path.parallel_safe);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Build the query string to be sent for execution, and identify
|
|
* expressions to be sent as parameters.
|
|
*/
|
|
initStringInfo(&sql);
|
|
deparseSelectStmtForRel(&sql, root, foreignrel, fdw_scan_tlist,
|
|
remote_exprs, best_path->path.pathkeys,
|
|
has_final_sort, has_limit, false,
|
|
&retrieved_attrs, ¶ms_list);
|
|
|
|
/* Remember remote_exprs for possible use by postgresPlanDirectModify */
|
|
fpinfo->final_remote_exprs = remote_exprs;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Build the fdw_private list that will be available to the executor.
|
|
* Items in the list must match order in enum FdwScanPrivateIndex.
|
|
*/
|
|
fdw_private = list_make3(makeString(sql.data),
|
|
retrieved_attrs,
|
|
makeInteger(fpinfo->fetch_size));
|
|
if (IS_JOIN_REL(foreignrel) || IS_UPPER_REL(foreignrel))
|
|
fdw_private = lappend(fdw_private,
|
|
makeString(fpinfo->relation_name));
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Create the ForeignScan node for the given relation.
|
|
*
|
|
* Note that the remote parameter expressions are stored in the fdw_exprs
|
|
* field of the finished plan node; we can't keep them in private state
|
|
* because then they wouldn't be subject to later planner processing.
|
|
*/
|
|
return make_foreignscan(tlist,
|
|
local_exprs,
|
|
scan_relid,
|
|
params_list,
|
|
fdw_private,
|
|
fdw_scan_tlist,
|
|
fdw_recheck_quals,
|
|
outer_plan);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Construct a tuple descriptor for the scan tuples handled by a foreign join.
|
|
*/
|
|
static TupleDesc
|
|
get_tupdesc_for_join_scan_tuples(ForeignScanState *node)
|
|
{
|
|
ForeignScan *fsplan = (ForeignScan *) node->ss.ps.plan;
|
|
EState *estate = node->ss.ps.state;
|
|
TupleDesc tupdesc;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* The core code has already set up a scan tuple slot based on
|
|
* fsplan->fdw_scan_tlist, and this slot's tupdesc is mostly good enough,
|
|
* but there's one case where it isn't. If we have any whole-row row
|
|
* identifier Vars, they may have vartype RECORD, and we need to replace
|
|
* that with the associated table's actual composite type. This ensures
|
|
* that when we read those ROW() expression values from the remote server,
|
|
* we can convert them to a composite type the local server knows.
|
|
*/
|
|
tupdesc = CreateTupleDescCopy(node->ss.ss_ScanTupleSlot->tts_tupleDescriptor);
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < tupdesc->natts; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
Form_pg_attribute att = TupleDescAttr(tupdesc, i);
|
|
Var *var;
|
|
RangeTblEntry *rte;
|
|
Oid reltype;
|
|
|
|
/* Nothing to do if it's not a generic RECORD attribute */
|
|
if (att->atttypid != RECORDOID || att->atttypmod >= 0)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If we can't identify the referenced table, do nothing. This'll
|
|
* likely lead to failure later, but perhaps we can muddle through.
|
|
*/
|
|
var = (Var *) list_nth_node(TargetEntry, fsplan->fdw_scan_tlist,
|
|
i)->expr;
|
|
if (!IsA(var, Var) || var->varattno != 0)
|
|
continue;
|
|
rte = list_nth(estate->es_range_table, var->varno - 1);
|
|
if (rte->rtekind != RTE_RELATION)
|
|
continue;
|
|
reltype = get_rel_type_id(rte->relid);
|
|
if (!OidIsValid(reltype))
|
|
continue;
|
|
att->atttypid = reltype;
|
|
/* shouldn't need to change anything else */
|
|
}
|
|
return tupdesc;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresBeginForeignScan
|
|
* Initiate an executor scan of a foreign PostgreSQL table.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
postgresBeginForeignScan(ForeignScanState *node, int eflags)
|
|
{
|
|
ForeignScan *fsplan = (ForeignScan *) node->ss.ps.plan;
|
|
EState *estate = node->ss.ps.state;
|
|
PgFdwScanState *fsstate;
|
|
RangeTblEntry *rte;
|
|
Oid userid;
|
|
ForeignTable *table;
|
|
UserMapping *user;
|
|
int rtindex;
|
|
int numParams;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Do nothing in EXPLAIN (no ANALYZE) case. node->fdw_state stays NULL.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (eflags & EXEC_FLAG_EXPLAIN_ONLY)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* We'll save private state in node->fdw_state.
|
|
*/
|
|
fsstate = (PgFdwScanState *) palloc0(sizeof(PgFdwScanState));
|
|
node->fdw_state = (void *) fsstate;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Identify which user to do the remote access as. This should match what
|
|
* ExecCheckRTEPerms() does. In case of a join or aggregate, use the
|
|
* lowest-numbered member RTE as a representative; we would get the same
|
|
* result from any.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fsplan->scan.scanrelid > 0)
|
|
rtindex = fsplan->scan.scanrelid;
|
|
else
|
|
rtindex = bms_next_member(fsplan->fs_relids, -1);
|
|
rte = exec_rt_fetch(rtindex, estate);
|
|
userid = rte->checkAsUser ? rte->checkAsUser : GetUserId();
|
|
|
|
/* Get info about foreign table. */
|
|
table = GetForeignTable(rte->relid);
|
|
user = GetUserMapping(userid, table->serverid);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Get connection to the foreign server. Connection manager will
|
|
* establish new connection if necessary.
|
|
*/
|
|
fsstate->conn = GetConnection(user, false, &fsstate->conn_state);
|
|
|
|
/* Assign a unique ID for my cursor */
|
|
fsstate->cursor_number = GetCursorNumber(fsstate->conn);
|
|
fsstate->cursor_exists = false;
|
|
|
|
/* Get private info created by planner functions. */
|
|
fsstate->query = strVal(list_nth(fsplan->fdw_private,
|
|
FdwScanPrivateSelectSql));
|
|
fsstate->retrieved_attrs = (List *) list_nth(fsplan->fdw_private,
|
|
FdwScanPrivateRetrievedAttrs);
|
|
fsstate->fetch_size = intVal(list_nth(fsplan->fdw_private,
|
|
FdwScanPrivateFetchSize));
|
|
|
|
/* Create contexts for batches of tuples and per-tuple temp workspace. */
|
|
fsstate->batch_cxt = AllocSetContextCreate(estate->es_query_cxt,
|
|
"postgres_fdw tuple data",
|
|
ALLOCSET_DEFAULT_SIZES);
|
|
fsstate->temp_cxt = AllocSetContextCreate(estate->es_query_cxt,
|
|
"postgres_fdw temporary data",
|
|
ALLOCSET_SMALL_SIZES);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Get info we'll need for converting data fetched from the foreign server
|
|
* into local representation and error reporting during that process.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fsplan->scan.scanrelid > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
fsstate->rel = node->ss.ss_currentRelation;
|
|
fsstate->tupdesc = RelationGetDescr(fsstate->rel);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
fsstate->rel = NULL;
|
|
fsstate->tupdesc = get_tupdesc_for_join_scan_tuples(node);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
fsstate->attinmeta = TupleDescGetAttInMetadata(fsstate->tupdesc);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Prepare for processing of parameters used in remote query, if any.
|
|
*/
|
|
numParams = list_length(fsplan->fdw_exprs);
|
|
fsstate->numParams = numParams;
|
|
if (numParams > 0)
|
|
prepare_query_params((PlanState *) node,
|
|
fsplan->fdw_exprs,
|
|
numParams,
|
|
&fsstate->param_flinfo,
|
|
&fsstate->param_exprs,
|
|
&fsstate->param_values);
|
|
|
|
/* Set the async-capable flag */
|
|
fsstate->async_capable = node->ss.ps.async_capable;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresIterateForeignScan
|
|
* Retrieve next row from the result set, or clear tuple slot to indicate
|
|
* EOF.
|
|
*/
|
|
static TupleTableSlot *
|
|
postgresIterateForeignScan(ForeignScanState *node)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwScanState *fsstate = (PgFdwScanState *) node->fdw_state;
|
|
TupleTableSlot *slot = node->ss.ss_ScanTupleSlot;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* In sync mode, if this is the first call after Begin or ReScan, we need
|
|
* to create the cursor on the remote side. In async mode, we would have
|
|
* already created the cursor before we get here, even if this is the
|
|
* first call after Begin or ReScan.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!fsstate->cursor_exists)
|
|
create_cursor(node);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Get some more tuples, if we've run out.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fsstate->next_tuple >= fsstate->num_tuples)
|
|
{
|
|
/* In async mode, just clear tuple slot. */
|
|
if (fsstate->async_capable)
|
|
return ExecClearTuple(slot);
|
|
/* No point in another fetch if we already detected EOF, though. */
|
|
if (!fsstate->eof_reached)
|
|
fetch_more_data(node);
|
|
/* If we didn't get any tuples, must be end of data. */
|
|
if (fsstate->next_tuple >= fsstate->num_tuples)
|
|
return ExecClearTuple(slot);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Return the next tuple.
|
|
*/
|
|
ExecStoreHeapTuple(fsstate->tuples[fsstate->next_tuple++],
|
|
slot,
|
|
false);
|
|
|
|
return slot;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresReScanForeignScan
|
|
* Restart the scan.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
postgresReScanForeignScan(ForeignScanState *node)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwScanState *fsstate = (PgFdwScanState *) node->fdw_state;
|
|
char sql[64];
|
|
PGresult *res;
|
|
|
|
/* If we haven't created the cursor yet, nothing to do. */
|
|
if (!fsstate->cursor_exists)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If the node is async-capable, and an asynchronous fetch for it has been
|
|
* begun, the asynchronous fetch might not have yet completed. Check if
|
|
* the node is async-capable, and an asynchronous fetch for it is still in
|
|
* progress; if so, complete the asynchronous fetch before restarting the
|
|
* scan.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fsstate->async_capable &&
|
|
fsstate->conn_state->pendingAreq &&
|
|
fsstate->conn_state->pendingAreq->requestee == (PlanState *) node)
|
|
fetch_more_data(node);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If any internal parameters affecting this node have changed, we'd
|
|
* better destroy and recreate the cursor. Otherwise, rewinding it should
|
|
* be good enough. If we've only fetched zero or one batch, we needn't
|
|
* even rewind the cursor, just rescan what we have.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (node->ss.ps.chgParam != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
fsstate->cursor_exists = false;
|
|
snprintf(sql, sizeof(sql), "CLOSE c%u",
|
|
fsstate->cursor_number);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (fsstate->fetch_ct_2 > 1)
|
|
{
|
|
snprintf(sql, sizeof(sql), "MOVE BACKWARD ALL IN c%u",
|
|
fsstate->cursor_number);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Easy: just rescan what we already have in memory, if anything */
|
|
fsstate->next_tuple = 0;
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* We don't use a PG_TRY block here, so be careful not to throw error
|
|
* without releasing the PGresult.
|
|
*/
|
|
res = pgfdw_exec_query(fsstate->conn, sql, fsstate->conn_state);
|
|
if (PQresultStatus(res) != PGRES_COMMAND_OK)
|
|
pgfdw_report_error(ERROR, res, fsstate->conn, true, sql);
|
|
PQclear(res);
|
|
|
|
/* Now force a fresh FETCH. */
|
|
fsstate->tuples = NULL;
|
|
fsstate->num_tuples = 0;
|
|
fsstate->next_tuple = 0;
|
|
fsstate->fetch_ct_2 = 0;
|
|
fsstate->eof_reached = false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresEndForeignScan
|
|
* Finish scanning foreign table and dispose objects used for this scan
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
postgresEndForeignScan(ForeignScanState *node)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwScanState *fsstate = (PgFdwScanState *) node->fdw_state;
|
|
|
|
/* if fsstate is NULL, we are in EXPLAIN; nothing to do */
|
|
if (fsstate == NULL)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/* Close the cursor if open, to prevent accumulation of cursors */
|
|
if (fsstate->cursor_exists)
|
|
close_cursor(fsstate->conn, fsstate->cursor_number,
|
|
fsstate->conn_state);
|
|
|
|
/* Release remote connection */
|
|
ReleaseConnection(fsstate->conn);
|
|
fsstate->conn = NULL;
|
|
|
|
/* MemoryContexts will be deleted automatically. */
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresAddForeignUpdateTargets
|
|
* Add resjunk column(s) needed for update/delete on a foreign table
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
postgresAddForeignUpdateTargets(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
Index rtindex,
|
|
RangeTblEntry *target_rte,
|
|
Relation target_relation)
|
|
{
|
|
Var *var;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* In postgres_fdw, what we need is the ctid, same as for a regular table.
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
/* Make a Var representing the desired value */
|
|
var = makeVar(rtindex,
|
|
SelfItemPointerAttributeNumber,
|
|
TIDOID,
|
|
-1,
|
|
InvalidOid,
|
|
0);
|
|
|
|
/* Register it as a row-identity column needed by this target rel */
|
|
add_row_identity_var(root, var, rtindex, "ctid");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresPlanForeignModify
|
|
* Plan an insert/update/delete operation on a foreign table
|
|
*/
|
|
static List *
|
|
postgresPlanForeignModify(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
ModifyTable *plan,
|
|
Index resultRelation,
|
|
int subplan_index)
|
|
{
|
|
CmdType operation = plan->operation;
|
|
RangeTblEntry *rte = planner_rt_fetch(resultRelation, root);
|
|
Relation rel;
|
|
StringInfoData sql;
|
|
List *targetAttrs = NIL;
|
|
List *withCheckOptionList = NIL;
|
|
List *returningList = NIL;
|
|
List *retrieved_attrs = NIL;
|
|
bool doNothing = false;
|
|
int values_end_len = -1;
|
|
|
|
initStringInfo(&sql);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Core code already has some lock on each rel being planned, so we can
|
|
* use NoLock here.
|
|
*/
|
|
rel = table_open(rte->relid, NoLock);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* In an INSERT, we transmit all columns that are defined in the foreign
|
|
* table. In an UPDATE, if there are BEFORE ROW UPDATE triggers on the
|
|
* foreign table, we transmit all columns like INSERT; else we transmit
|
|
* only columns that were explicitly targets of the UPDATE, so as to avoid
|
|
* unnecessary data transmission. (We can't do that for INSERT since we
|
|
* would miss sending default values for columns not listed in the source
|
|
* statement, and for UPDATE if there are BEFORE ROW UPDATE triggers since
|
|
* those triggers might change values for non-target columns, in which
|
|
* case we would miss sending changed values for those columns.)
|
|
*/
|
|
if (operation == CMD_INSERT ||
|
|
(operation == CMD_UPDATE &&
|
|
rel->trigdesc &&
|
|
rel->trigdesc->trig_update_before_row))
|
|
{
|
|
TupleDesc tupdesc = RelationGetDescr(rel);
|
|
int attnum;
|
|
|
|
for (attnum = 1; attnum <= tupdesc->natts; attnum++)
|
|
{
|
|
Form_pg_attribute attr = TupleDescAttr(tupdesc, attnum - 1);
|
|
|
|
if (!attr->attisdropped)
|
|
targetAttrs = lappend_int(targetAttrs, attnum);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if (operation == CMD_UPDATE)
|
|
{
|
|
int col;
|
|
RelOptInfo *rel = find_base_rel(root, resultRelation);
|
|
Bitmapset *allUpdatedCols = get_rel_all_updated_cols(root, rel);
|
|
|
|
col = -1;
|
|
while ((col = bms_next_member(allUpdatedCols, col)) >= 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* bit numbers are offset by FirstLowInvalidHeapAttributeNumber */
|
|
AttrNumber attno = col + FirstLowInvalidHeapAttributeNumber;
|
|
|
|
if (attno <= InvalidAttrNumber) /* shouldn't happen */
|
|
elog(ERROR, "system-column update is not supported");
|
|
targetAttrs = lappend_int(targetAttrs, attno);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Extract the relevant WITH CHECK OPTION list if any.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (plan->withCheckOptionLists)
|
|
withCheckOptionList = (List *) list_nth(plan->withCheckOptionLists,
|
|
subplan_index);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Extract the relevant RETURNING list if any.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (plan->returningLists)
|
|
returningList = (List *) list_nth(plan->returningLists, subplan_index);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* ON CONFLICT DO UPDATE and DO NOTHING case with inference specification
|
|
* should have already been rejected in the optimizer, as presently there
|
|
* is no way to recognize an arbiter index on a foreign table. Only DO
|
|
* NOTHING is supported without an inference specification.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (plan->onConflictAction == ONCONFLICT_NOTHING)
|
|
doNothing = true;
|
|
else if (plan->onConflictAction != ONCONFLICT_NONE)
|
|
elog(ERROR, "unexpected ON CONFLICT specification: %d",
|
|
(int) plan->onConflictAction);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Construct the SQL command string.
|
|
*/
|
|
switch (operation)
|
|
{
|
|
case CMD_INSERT:
|
|
deparseInsertSql(&sql, rte, resultRelation, rel,
|
|
targetAttrs, doNothing,
|
|
withCheckOptionList, returningList,
|
|
&retrieved_attrs, &values_end_len);
|
|
break;
|
|
case CMD_UPDATE:
|
|
deparseUpdateSql(&sql, rte, resultRelation, rel,
|
|
targetAttrs,
|
|
withCheckOptionList, returningList,
|
|
&retrieved_attrs);
|
|
break;
|
|
case CMD_DELETE:
|
|
deparseDeleteSql(&sql, rte, resultRelation, rel,
|
|
returningList,
|
|
&retrieved_attrs);
|
|
break;
|
|
default:
|
|
elog(ERROR, "unexpected operation: %d", (int) operation);
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
table_close(rel, NoLock);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Build the fdw_private list that will be available to the executor.
|
|
* Items in the list must match enum FdwModifyPrivateIndex, above.
|
|
*/
|
|
return list_make5(makeString(sql.data),
|
|
targetAttrs,
|
|
makeInteger(values_end_len),
|
|
makeBoolean((retrieved_attrs != NIL)),
|
|
retrieved_attrs);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresBeginForeignModify
|
|
* Begin an insert/update/delete operation on a foreign table
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
postgresBeginForeignModify(ModifyTableState *mtstate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo,
|
|
List *fdw_private,
|
|
int subplan_index,
|
|
int eflags)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwModifyState *fmstate;
|
|
char *query;
|
|
List *target_attrs;
|
|
bool has_returning;
|
|
int values_end_len;
|
|
List *retrieved_attrs;
|
|
RangeTblEntry *rte;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Do nothing in EXPLAIN (no ANALYZE) case. resultRelInfo->ri_FdwState
|
|
* stays NULL.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (eflags & EXEC_FLAG_EXPLAIN_ONLY)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/* Deconstruct fdw_private data. */
|
|
query = strVal(list_nth(fdw_private,
|
|
FdwModifyPrivateUpdateSql));
|
|
target_attrs = (List *) list_nth(fdw_private,
|
|
FdwModifyPrivateTargetAttnums);
|
|
values_end_len = intVal(list_nth(fdw_private,
|
|
FdwModifyPrivateLen));
|
|
has_returning = boolVal(list_nth(fdw_private,
|
|
FdwModifyPrivateHasReturning));
|
|
retrieved_attrs = (List *) list_nth(fdw_private,
|
|
FdwModifyPrivateRetrievedAttrs);
|
|
|
|
/* Find RTE. */
|
|
rte = exec_rt_fetch(resultRelInfo->ri_RangeTableIndex,
|
|
mtstate->ps.state);
|
|
|
|
/* Construct an execution state. */
|
|
fmstate = create_foreign_modify(mtstate->ps.state,
|
|
rte,
|
|
resultRelInfo,
|
|
mtstate->operation,
|
|
outerPlanState(mtstate)->plan,
|
|
query,
|
|
target_attrs,
|
|
values_end_len,
|
|
has_returning,
|
|
retrieved_attrs);
|
|
|
|
resultRelInfo->ri_FdwState = fmstate;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresExecForeignInsert
|
|
* Insert one row into a foreign table
|
|
*/
|
|
static TupleTableSlot *
|
|
postgresExecForeignInsert(EState *estate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo,
|
|
TupleTableSlot *slot,
|
|
TupleTableSlot *planSlot)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwModifyState *fmstate = (PgFdwModifyState *) resultRelInfo->ri_FdwState;
|
|
TupleTableSlot **rslot;
|
|
int numSlots = 1;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If the fmstate has aux_fmstate set, use the aux_fmstate (see
|
|
* postgresBeginForeignInsert())
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fmstate->aux_fmstate)
|
|
resultRelInfo->ri_FdwState = fmstate->aux_fmstate;
|
|
rslot = execute_foreign_modify(estate, resultRelInfo, CMD_INSERT,
|
|
&slot, &planSlot, &numSlots);
|
|
/* Revert that change */
|
|
if (fmstate->aux_fmstate)
|
|
resultRelInfo->ri_FdwState = fmstate;
|
|
|
|
return rslot ? *rslot : NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresExecForeignBatchInsert
|
|
* Insert multiple rows into a foreign table
|
|
*/
|
|
static TupleTableSlot **
|
|
postgresExecForeignBatchInsert(EState *estate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo,
|
|
TupleTableSlot **slots,
|
|
TupleTableSlot **planSlots,
|
|
int *numSlots)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwModifyState *fmstate = (PgFdwModifyState *) resultRelInfo->ri_FdwState;
|
|
TupleTableSlot **rslot;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If the fmstate has aux_fmstate set, use the aux_fmstate (see
|
|
* postgresBeginForeignInsert())
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fmstate->aux_fmstate)
|
|
resultRelInfo->ri_FdwState = fmstate->aux_fmstate;
|
|
rslot = execute_foreign_modify(estate, resultRelInfo, CMD_INSERT,
|
|
slots, planSlots, numSlots);
|
|
/* Revert that change */
|
|
if (fmstate->aux_fmstate)
|
|
resultRelInfo->ri_FdwState = fmstate;
|
|
|
|
return rslot;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresGetForeignModifyBatchSize
|
|
* Determine the maximum number of tuples that can be inserted in bulk
|
|
*
|
|
* Returns the batch size specified for server or table. When batching is not
|
|
* allowed (e.g. for tables with BEFORE/AFTER ROW triggers or with RETURNING
|
|
* clause), returns 1.
|
|
*/
|
|
static int
|
|
postgresGetForeignModifyBatchSize(ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo)
|
|
{
|
|
int batch_size;
|
|
PgFdwModifyState *fmstate = resultRelInfo->ri_FdwState ?
|
|
(PgFdwModifyState *) resultRelInfo->ri_FdwState :
|
|
NULL;
|
|
|
|
/* should be called only once */
|
|
Assert(resultRelInfo->ri_BatchSize == 0);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Should never get called when the insert is being performed as part of a
|
|
* row movement operation.
|
|
*/
|
|
Assert(fmstate == NULL || fmstate->aux_fmstate == NULL);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* In EXPLAIN without ANALYZE, ri_FdwState is NULL, so we have to lookup
|
|
* the option directly in server/table options. Otherwise just use the
|
|
* value we determined earlier.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fmstate)
|
|
batch_size = fmstate->batch_size;
|
|
else
|
|
batch_size = get_batch_size_option(resultRelInfo->ri_RelationDesc);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Disable batching when we have to use RETURNING, there are any
|
|
* BEFORE/AFTER ROW INSERT triggers on the foreign table, or there are any
|
|
* WITH CHECK OPTION constraints from parent views.
|
|
*
|
|
* When there are any BEFORE ROW INSERT triggers on the table, we can't
|
|
* support it, because such triggers might query the table we're inserting
|
|
* into and act differently if the tuples that have already been processed
|
|
* and prepared for insertion are not there.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (resultRelInfo->ri_projectReturning != NULL ||
|
|
resultRelInfo->ri_WithCheckOptions != NIL ||
|
|
(resultRelInfo->ri_TrigDesc &&
|
|
(resultRelInfo->ri_TrigDesc->trig_insert_before_row ||
|
|
resultRelInfo->ri_TrigDesc->trig_insert_after_row)))
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Otherwise use the batch size specified for server/table. The number of
|
|
* parameters in a batch is limited to 65535 (uint16), so make sure we
|
|
* don't exceed this limit by using the maximum batch_size possible.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fmstate && fmstate->p_nums > 0)
|
|
batch_size = Min(batch_size, PQ_QUERY_PARAM_MAX_LIMIT / fmstate->p_nums);
|
|
|
|
return batch_size;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresExecForeignUpdate
|
|
* Update one row in a foreign table
|
|
*/
|
|
static TupleTableSlot *
|
|
postgresExecForeignUpdate(EState *estate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo,
|
|
TupleTableSlot *slot,
|
|
TupleTableSlot *planSlot)
|
|
{
|
|
TupleTableSlot **rslot;
|
|
int numSlots = 1;
|
|
|
|
rslot = execute_foreign_modify(estate, resultRelInfo, CMD_UPDATE,
|
|
&slot, &planSlot, &numSlots);
|
|
|
|
return rslot ? rslot[0] : NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresExecForeignDelete
|
|
* Delete one row from a foreign table
|
|
*/
|
|
static TupleTableSlot *
|
|
postgresExecForeignDelete(EState *estate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo,
|
|
TupleTableSlot *slot,
|
|
TupleTableSlot *planSlot)
|
|
{
|
|
TupleTableSlot **rslot;
|
|
int numSlots = 1;
|
|
|
|
rslot = execute_foreign_modify(estate, resultRelInfo, CMD_DELETE,
|
|
&slot, &planSlot, &numSlots);
|
|
|
|
return rslot ? rslot[0] : NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresEndForeignModify
|
|
* Finish an insert/update/delete operation on a foreign table
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
postgresEndForeignModify(EState *estate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwModifyState *fmstate = (PgFdwModifyState *) resultRelInfo->ri_FdwState;
|
|
|
|
/* If fmstate is NULL, we are in EXPLAIN; nothing to do */
|
|
if (fmstate == NULL)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/* Destroy the execution state */
|
|
finish_foreign_modify(fmstate);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresBeginForeignInsert
|
|
* Begin an insert operation on a foreign table
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
postgresBeginForeignInsert(ModifyTableState *mtstate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwModifyState *fmstate;
|
|
ModifyTable *plan = castNode(ModifyTable, mtstate->ps.plan);
|
|
EState *estate = mtstate->ps.state;
|
|
Index resultRelation;
|
|
Relation rel = resultRelInfo->ri_RelationDesc;
|
|
RangeTblEntry *rte;
|
|
TupleDesc tupdesc = RelationGetDescr(rel);
|
|
int attnum;
|
|
int values_end_len;
|
|
StringInfoData sql;
|
|
List *targetAttrs = NIL;
|
|
List *retrieved_attrs = NIL;
|
|
bool doNothing = false;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If the foreign table we are about to insert routed rows into is also an
|
|
* UPDATE subplan result rel that will be updated later, proceeding with
|
|
* the INSERT will result in the later UPDATE incorrectly modifying those
|
|
* routed rows, so prevent the INSERT --- it would be nice if we could
|
|
* handle this case; but for now, throw an error for safety.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (plan && plan->operation == CMD_UPDATE &&
|
|
(resultRelInfo->ri_usesFdwDirectModify ||
|
|
resultRelInfo->ri_FdwState))
|
|
ereport(ERROR,
|
|
(errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
|
|
errmsg("cannot route tuples into foreign table to be updated \"%s\"",
|
|
RelationGetRelationName(rel))));
|
|
|
|
initStringInfo(&sql);
|
|
|
|
/* We transmit all columns that are defined in the foreign table. */
|
|
for (attnum = 1; attnum <= tupdesc->natts; attnum++)
|
|
{
|
|
Form_pg_attribute attr = TupleDescAttr(tupdesc, attnum - 1);
|
|
|
|
if (!attr->attisdropped)
|
|
targetAttrs = lappend_int(targetAttrs, attnum);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Check if we add the ON CONFLICT clause to the remote query. */
|
|
if (plan)
|
|
{
|
|
OnConflictAction onConflictAction = plan->onConflictAction;
|
|
|
|
/* We only support DO NOTHING without an inference specification. */
|
|
if (onConflictAction == ONCONFLICT_NOTHING)
|
|
doNothing = true;
|
|
else if (onConflictAction != ONCONFLICT_NONE)
|
|
elog(ERROR, "unexpected ON CONFLICT specification: %d",
|
|
(int) onConflictAction);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If the foreign table is a partition that doesn't have a corresponding
|
|
* RTE entry, we need to create a new RTE describing the foreign table for
|
|
* use by deparseInsertSql and create_foreign_modify() below, after first
|
|
* copying the parent's RTE and modifying some fields to describe the
|
|
* foreign partition to work on. However, if this is invoked by UPDATE,
|
|
* the existing RTE may already correspond to this partition if it is one
|
|
* of the UPDATE subplan target rels; in that case, we can just use the
|
|
* existing RTE as-is.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (resultRelInfo->ri_RangeTableIndex == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
ResultRelInfo *rootResultRelInfo = resultRelInfo->ri_RootResultRelInfo;
|
|
|
|
rte = exec_rt_fetch(rootResultRelInfo->ri_RangeTableIndex, estate);
|
|
rte = copyObject(rte);
|
|
rte->relid = RelationGetRelid(rel);
|
|
rte->relkind = RELKIND_FOREIGN_TABLE;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* For UPDATE, we must use the RT index of the first subplan target
|
|
* rel's RTE, because the core code would have built expressions for
|
|
* the partition, such as RETURNING, using that RT index as varno of
|
|
* Vars contained in those expressions.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (plan && plan->operation == CMD_UPDATE &&
|
|
rootResultRelInfo->ri_RangeTableIndex == plan->rootRelation)
|
|
resultRelation = mtstate->resultRelInfo[0].ri_RangeTableIndex;
|
|
else
|
|
resultRelation = rootResultRelInfo->ri_RangeTableIndex;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
resultRelation = resultRelInfo->ri_RangeTableIndex;
|
|
rte = exec_rt_fetch(resultRelation, estate);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Construct the SQL command string. */
|
|
deparseInsertSql(&sql, rte, resultRelation, rel, targetAttrs, doNothing,
|
|
resultRelInfo->ri_WithCheckOptions,
|
|
resultRelInfo->ri_returningList,
|
|
&retrieved_attrs, &values_end_len);
|
|
|
|
/* Construct an execution state. */
|
|
fmstate = create_foreign_modify(mtstate->ps.state,
|
|
rte,
|
|
resultRelInfo,
|
|
CMD_INSERT,
|
|
NULL,
|
|
sql.data,
|
|
targetAttrs,
|
|
values_end_len,
|
|
retrieved_attrs != NIL,
|
|
retrieved_attrs);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If the given resultRelInfo already has PgFdwModifyState set, it means
|
|
* the foreign table is an UPDATE subplan result rel; in which case, store
|
|
* the resulting state into the aux_fmstate of the PgFdwModifyState.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (resultRelInfo->ri_FdwState)
|
|
{
|
|
Assert(plan && plan->operation == CMD_UPDATE);
|
|
Assert(resultRelInfo->ri_usesFdwDirectModify == false);
|
|
((PgFdwModifyState *) resultRelInfo->ri_FdwState)->aux_fmstate = fmstate;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
resultRelInfo->ri_FdwState = fmstate;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresEndForeignInsert
|
|
* Finish an insert operation on a foreign table
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
postgresEndForeignInsert(EState *estate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwModifyState *fmstate = (PgFdwModifyState *) resultRelInfo->ri_FdwState;
|
|
|
|
Assert(fmstate != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If the fmstate has aux_fmstate set, get the aux_fmstate (see
|
|
* postgresBeginForeignInsert())
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fmstate->aux_fmstate)
|
|
fmstate = fmstate->aux_fmstate;
|
|
|
|
/* Destroy the execution state */
|
|
finish_foreign_modify(fmstate);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresIsForeignRelUpdatable
|
|
* Determine whether a foreign table supports INSERT, UPDATE and/or
|
|
* DELETE.
|
|
*/
|
|
static int
|
|
postgresIsForeignRelUpdatable(Relation rel)
|
|
{
|
|
bool updatable;
|
|
ForeignTable *table;
|
|
ForeignServer *server;
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* By default, all postgres_fdw foreign tables are assumed updatable. This
|
|
* can be overridden by a per-server setting, which in turn can be
|
|
* overridden by a per-table setting.
|
|
*/
|
|
updatable = true;
|
|
|
|
table = GetForeignTable(RelationGetRelid(rel));
|
|
server = GetForeignServer(table->serverid);
|
|
|
|
foreach(lc, server->options)
|
|
{
|
|
DefElem *def = (DefElem *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
|
|
if (strcmp(def->defname, "updatable") == 0)
|
|
updatable = defGetBoolean(def);
|
|
}
|
|
foreach(lc, table->options)
|
|
{
|
|
DefElem *def = (DefElem *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
|
|
if (strcmp(def->defname, "updatable") == 0)
|
|
updatable = defGetBoolean(def);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Currently "updatable" means support for INSERT, UPDATE and DELETE.
|
|
*/
|
|
return updatable ?
|
|
(1 << CMD_INSERT) | (1 << CMD_UPDATE) | (1 << CMD_DELETE) : 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresRecheckForeignScan
|
|
* Execute a local join execution plan for a foreign join
|
|
*/
|
|
static bool
|
|
postgresRecheckForeignScan(ForeignScanState *node, TupleTableSlot *slot)
|
|
{
|
|
Index scanrelid = ((Scan *) node->ss.ps.plan)->scanrelid;
|
|
PlanState *outerPlan = outerPlanState(node);
|
|
TupleTableSlot *result;
|
|
|
|
/* For base foreign relations, it suffices to set fdw_recheck_quals */
|
|
if (scanrelid > 0)
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
Assert(outerPlan != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* Execute a local join execution plan */
|
|
result = ExecProcNode(outerPlan);
|
|
if (TupIsNull(result))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
/* Store result in the given slot */
|
|
ExecCopySlot(slot, result);
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* find_modifytable_subplan
|
|
* Helper routine for postgresPlanDirectModify to find the
|
|
* ModifyTable subplan node that scans the specified RTI.
|
|
*
|
|
* Returns NULL if the subplan couldn't be identified. That's not a fatal
|
|
* error condition, we just abandon trying to do the update directly.
|
|
*/
|
|
static ForeignScan *
|
|
find_modifytable_subplan(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
ModifyTable *plan,
|
|
Index rtindex,
|
|
int subplan_index)
|
|
{
|
|
Plan *subplan = outerPlan(plan);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* The cases we support are (1) the desired ForeignScan is the immediate
|
|
* child of ModifyTable, or (2) it is the subplan_index'th child of an
|
|
* Append node that is the immediate child of ModifyTable. There is no
|
|
* point in looking further down, as that would mean that local joins are
|
|
* involved, so we can't do the update directly.
|
|
*
|
|
* There could be a Result atop the Append too, acting to compute the
|
|
* UPDATE targetlist values. We ignore that here; the tlist will be
|
|
* checked by our caller.
|
|
*
|
|
* In principle we could examine all the children of the Append, but it's
|
|
* currently unlikely that the core planner would generate such a plan
|
|
* with the children out-of-order. Moreover, such a search risks costing
|
|
* O(N^2) time when there are a lot of children.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (IsA(subplan, Append))
|
|
{
|
|
Append *appendplan = (Append *) subplan;
|
|
|
|
if (subplan_index < list_length(appendplan->appendplans))
|
|
subplan = (Plan *) list_nth(appendplan->appendplans, subplan_index);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (IsA(subplan, Result) &&
|
|
outerPlan(subplan) != NULL &&
|
|
IsA(outerPlan(subplan), Append))
|
|
{
|
|
Append *appendplan = (Append *) outerPlan(subplan);
|
|
|
|
if (subplan_index < list_length(appendplan->appendplans))
|
|
subplan = (Plan *) list_nth(appendplan->appendplans, subplan_index);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Now, have we got a ForeignScan on the desired rel? */
|
|
if (IsA(subplan, ForeignScan))
|
|
{
|
|
ForeignScan *fscan = (ForeignScan *) subplan;
|
|
|
|
if (bms_is_member(rtindex, fscan->fs_relids))
|
|
return fscan;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresPlanDirectModify
|
|
* Consider a direct foreign table modification
|
|
*
|
|
* Decide whether it is safe to modify a foreign table directly, and if so,
|
|
* rewrite subplan accordingly.
|
|
*/
|
|
static bool
|
|
postgresPlanDirectModify(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
ModifyTable *plan,
|
|
Index resultRelation,
|
|
int subplan_index)
|
|
{
|
|
CmdType operation = plan->operation;
|
|
RelOptInfo *foreignrel;
|
|
RangeTblEntry *rte;
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo;
|
|
Relation rel;
|
|
StringInfoData sql;
|
|
ForeignScan *fscan;
|
|
List *processed_tlist = NIL;
|
|
List *targetAttrs = NIL;
|
|
List *remote_exprs;
|
|
List *params_list = NIL;
|
|
List *returningList = NIL;
|
|
List *retrieved_attrs = NIL;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Decide whether it is safe to modify a foreign table directly.
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* The table modification must be an UPDATE or DELETE.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (operation != CMD_UPDATE && operation != CMD_DELETE)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Try to locate the ForeignScan subplan that's scanning resultRelation.
|
|
*/
|
|
fscan = find_modifytable_subplan(root, plan, resultRelation, subplan_index);
|
|
if (!fscan)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* It's unsafe to modify a foreign table directly if there are any quals
|
|
* that should be evaluated locally.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fscan->scan.plan.qual != NIL)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
/* Safe to fetch data about the target foreign rel */
|
|
if (fscan->scan.scanrelid == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
foreignrel = find_join_rel(root, fscan->fs_relids);
|
|
/* We should have a rel for this foreign join. */
|
|
Assert(foreignrel);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
foreignrel = root->simple_rel_array[resultRelation];
|
|
rte = root->simple_rte_array[resultRelation];
|
|
fpinfo = (PgFdwRelationInfo *) foreignrel->fdw_private;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* It's unsafe to update a foreign table directly, if any expressions to
|
|
* assign to the target columns are unsafe to evaluate remotely.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (operation == CMD_UPDATE)
|
|
{
|
|
ListCell *lc,
|
|
*lc2;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* The expressions of concern are the first N columns of the processed
|
|
* targetlist, where N is the length of the rel's update_colnos.
|
|
*/
|
|
get_translated_update_targetlist(root, resultRelation,
|
|
&processed_tlist, &targetAttrs);
|
|
forboth(lc, processed_tlist, lc2, targetAttrs)
|
|
{
|
|
TargetEntry *tle = lfirst_node(TargetEntry, lc);
|
|
AttrNumber attno = lfirst_int(lc2);
|
|
|
|
/* update's new-value expressions shouldn't be resjunk */
|
|
Assert(!tle->resjunk);
|
|
|
|
if (attno <= InvalidAttrNumber) /* shouldn't happen */
|
|
elog(ERROR, "system-column update is not supported");
|
|
|
|
if (!is_foreign_expr(root, foreignrel, (Expr *) tle->expr))
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Ok, rewrite subplan so as to modify the foreign table directly.
|
|
*/
|
|
initStringInfo(&sql);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Core code already has some lock on each rel being planned, so we can
|
|
* use NoLock here.
|
|
*/
|
|
rel = table_open(rte->relid, NoLock);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Recall the qual clauses that must be evaluated remotely. (These are
|
|
* bare clauses not RestrictInfos, but deparse.c's appendConditions()
|
|
* doesn't care.)
|
|
*/
|
|
remote_exprs = fpinfo->final_remote_exprs;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Extract the relevant RETURNING list if any.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (plan->returningLists)
|
|
{
|
|
returningList = (List *) list_nth(plan->returningLists, subplan_index);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* When performing an UPDATE/DELETE .. RETURNING on a join directly,
|
|
* we fetch from the foreign server any Vars specified in RETURNING
|
|
* that refer not only to the target relation but to non-target
|
|
* relations. So we'll deparse them into the RETURNING clause of the
|
|
* remote query; use a targetlist consisting of them instead, which
|
|
* will be adjusted to be new fdw_scan_tlist of the foreign-scan plan
|
|
* node below.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fscan->scan.scanrelid == 0)
|
|
returningList = build_remote_returning(resultRelation, rel,
|
|
returningList);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Construct the SQL command string.
|
|
*/
|
|
switch (operation)
|
|
{
|
|
case CMD_UPDATE:
|
|
deparseDirectUpdateSql(&sql, root, resultRelation, rel,
|
|
foreignrel,
|
|
processed_tlist,
|
|
targetAttrs,
|
|
remote_exprs, ¶ms_list,
|
|
returningList, &retrieved_attrs);
|
|
break;
|
|
case CMD_DELETE:
|
|
deparseDirectDeleteSql(&sql, root, resultRelation, rel,
|
|
foreignrel,
|
|
remote_exprs, ¶ms_list,
|
|
returningList, &retrieved_attrs);
|
|
break;
|
|
default:
|
|
elog(ERROR, "unexpected operation: %d", (int) operation);
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Update the operation and target relation info.
|
|
*/
|
|
fscan->operation = operation;
|
|
fscan->resultRelation = resultRelation;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Update the fdw_exprs list that will be available to the executor.
|
|
*/
|
|
fscan->fdw_exprs = params_list;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Update the fdw_private list that will be available to the executor.
|
|
* Items in the list must match enum FdwDirectModifyPrivateIndex, above.
|
|
*/
|
|
fscan->fdw_private = list_make4(makeString(sql.data),
|
|
makeBoolean((retrieved_attrs != NIL)),
|
|
retrieved_attrs,
|
|
makeBoolean(plan->canSetTag));
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Update the foreign-join-related fields.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fscan->scan.scanrelid == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* No need for the outer subplan. */
|
|
fscan->scan.plan.lefttree = NULL;
|
|
|
|
/* Build new fdw_scan_tlist if UPDATE/DELETE .. RETURNING. */
|
|
if (returningList)
|
|
rebuild_fdw_scan_tlist(fscan, returningList);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Finally, unset the async-capable flag if it is set, as we currently
|
|
* don't support asynchronous execution of direct modifications.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fscan->scan.plan.async_capable)
|
|
fscan->scan.plan.async_capable = false;
|
|
|
|
table_close(rel, NoLock);
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresBeginDirectModify
|
|
* Prepare a direct foreign table modification
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
postgresBeginDirectModify(ForeignScanState *node, int eflags)
|
|
{
|
|
ForeignScan *fsplan = (ForeignScan *) node->ss.ps.plan;
|
|
EState *estate = node->ss.ps.state;
|
|
PgFdwDirectModifyState *dmstate;
|
|
Index rtindex;
|
|
RangeTblEntry *rte;
|
|
Oid userid;
|
|
ForeignTable *table;
|
|
UserMapping *user;
|
|
int numParams;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Do nothing in EXPLAIN (no ANALYZE) case. node->fdw_state stays NULL.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (eflags & EXEC_FLAG_EXPLAIN_ONLY)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* We'll save private state in node->fdw_state.
|
|
*/
|
|
dmstate = (PgFdwDirectModifyState *) palloc0(sizeof(PgFdwDirectModifyState));
|
|
node->fdw_state = (void *) dmstate;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Identify which user to do the remote access as. This should match what
|
|
* ExecCheckRTEPerms() does.
|
|
*/
|
|
rtindex = node->resultRelInfo->ri_RangeTableIndex;
|
|
rte = exec_rt_fetch(rtindex, estate);
|
|
userid = rte->checkAsUser ? rte->checkAsUser : GetUserId();
|
|
|
|
/* Get info about foreign table. */
|
|
if (fsplan->scan.scanrelid == 0)
|
|
dmstate->rel = ExecOpenScanRelation(estate, rtindex, eflags);
|
|
else
|
|
dmstate->rel = node->ss.ss_currentRelation;
|
|
table = GetForeignTable(RelationGetRelid(dmstate->rel));
|
|
user = GetUserMapping(userid, table->serverid);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Get connection to the foreign server. Connection manager will
|
|
* establish new connection if necessary.
|
|
*/
|
|
dmstate->conn = GetConnection(user, false, &dmstate->conn_state);
|
|
|
|
/* Update the foreign-join-related fields. */
|
|
if (fsplan->scan.scanrelid == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Save info about foreign table. */
|
|
dmstate->resultRel = dmstate->rel;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Set dmstate->rel to NULL to teach get_returning_data() and
|
|
* make_tuple_from_result_row() that columns fetched from the remote
|
|
* server are described by fdw_scan_tlist of the foreign-scan plan
|
|
* node, not the tuple descriptor for the target relation.
|
|
*/
|
|
dmstate->rel = NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Initialize state variable */
|
|
dmstate->num_tuples = -1; /* -1 means not set yet */
|
|
|
|
/* Get private info created by planner functions. */
|
|
dmstate->query = strVal(list_nth(fsplan->fdw_private,
|
|
FdwDirectModifyPrivateUpdateSql));
|
|
dmstate->has_returning = boolVal(list_nth(fsplan->fdw_private,
|
|
FdwDirectModifyPrivateHasReturning));
|
|
dmstate->retrieved_attrs = (List *) list_nth(fsplan->fdw_private,
|
|
FdwDirectModifyPrivateRetrievedAttrs);
|
|
dmstate->set_processed = boolVal(list_nth(fsplan->fdw_private,
|
|
FdwDirectModifyPrivateSetProcessed));
|
|
|
|
/* Create context for per-tuple temp workspace. */
|
|
dmstate->temp_cxt = AllocSetContextCreate(estate->es_query_cxt,
|
|
"postgres_fdw temporary data",
|
|
ALLOCSET_SMALL_SIZES);
|
|
|
|
/* Prepare for input conversion of RETURNING results. */
|
|
if (dmstate->has_returning)
|
|
{
|
|
TupleDesc tupdesc;
|
|
|
|
if (fsplan->scan.scanrelid == 0)
|
|
tupdesc = get_tupdesc_for_join_scan_tuples(node);
|
|
else
|
|
tupdesc = RelationGetDescr(dmstate->rel);
|
|
|
|
dmstate->attinmeta = TupleDescGetAttInMetadata(tupdesc);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* When performing an UPDATE/DELETE .. RETURNING on a join directly,
|
|
* initialize a filter to extract an updated/deleted tuple from a scan
|
|
* tuple.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fsplan->scan.scanrelid == 0)
|
|
init_returning_filter(dmstate, fsplan->fdw_scan_tlist, rtindex);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Prepare for processing of parameters used in remote query, if any.
|
|
*/
|
|
numParams = list_length(fsplan->fdw_exprs);
|
|
dmstate->numParams = numParams;
|
|
if (numParams > 0)
|
|
prepare_query_params((PlanState *) node,
|
|
fsplan->fdw_exprs,
|
|
numParams,
|
|
&dmstate->param_flinfo,
|
|
&dmstate->param_exprs,
|
|
&dmstate->param_values);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresIterateDirectModify
|
|
* Execute a direct foreign table modification
|
|
*/
|
|
static TupleTableSlot *
|
|
postgresIterateDirectModify(ForeignScanState *node)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwDirectModifyState *dmstate = (PgFdwDirectModifyState *) node->fdw_state;
|
|
EState *estate = node->ss.ps.state;
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo = node->resultRelInfo;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If this is the first call after Begin, execute the statement.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (dmstate->num_tuples == -1)
|
|
execute_dml_stmt(node);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If the local query doesn't specify RETURNING, just clear tuple slot.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!resultRelInfo->ri_projectReturning)
|
|
{
|
|
TupleTableSlot *slot = node->ss.ss_ScanTupleSlot;
|
|
Instrumentation *instr = node->ss.ps.instrument;
|
|
|
|
Assert(!dmstate->has_returning);
|
|
|
|
/* Increment the command es_processed count if necessary. */
|
|
if (dmstate->set_processed)
|
|
estate->es_processed += dmstate->num_tuples;
|
|
|
|
/* Increment the tuple count for EXPLAIN ANALYZE if necessary. */
|
|
if (instr)
|
|
instr->tuplecount += dmstate->num_tuples;
|
|
|
|
return ExecClearTuple(slot);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Get the next RETURNING tuple.
|
|
*/
|
|
return get_returning_data(node);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresEndDirectModify
|
|
* Finish a direct foreign table modification
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
postgresEndDirectModify(ForeignScanState *node)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwDirectModifyState *dmstate = (PgFdwDirectModifyState *) node->fdw_state;
|
|
|
|
/* if dmstate is NULL, we are in EXPLAIN; nothing to do */
|
|
if (dmstate == NULL)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/* Release PGresult */
|
|
if (dmstate->result)
|
|
PQclear(dmstate->result);
|
|
|
|
/* Release remote connection */
|
|
ReleaseConnection(dmstate->conn);
|
|
dmstate->conn = NULL;
|
|
|
|
/* MemoryContext will be deleted automatically. */
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresExplainForeignScan
|
|
* Produce extra output for EXPLAIN of a ForeignScan on a foreign table
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
postgresExplainForeignScan(ForeignScanState *node, ExplainState *es)
|
|
{
|
|
ForeignScan *plan = castNode(ForeignScan, node->ss.ps.plan);
|
|
List *fdw_private = plan->fdw_private;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Identify foreign scans that are really joins or upper relations. The
|
|
* input looks something like "(1) LEFT JOIN (2)", and we must replace the
|
|
* digit string(s), which are RT indexes, with the correct relation names.
|
|
* We do that here, not when the plan is created, because we can't know
|
|
* what aliases ruleutils.c will assign at plan creation time.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (list_length(fdw_private) > FdwScanPrivateRelations)
|
|
{
|
|
StringInfo relations;
|
|
char *rawrelations;
|
|
char *ptr;
|
|
int minrti,
|
|
rtoffset;
|
|
|
|
rawrelations = strVal(list_nth(fdw_private, FdwScanPrivateRelations));
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* A difficulty with using a string representation of RT indexes is
|
|
* that setrefs.c won't update the string when flattening the
|
|
* rangetable. To find out what rtoffset was applied, identify the
|
|
* minimum RT index appearing in the string and compare it to the
|
|
* minimum member of plan->fs_relids. (We expect all the relids in
|
|
* the join will have been offset by the same amount; the Asserts
|
|
* below should catch it if that ever changes.)
|
|
*/
|
|
minrti = INT_MAX;
|
|
ptr = rawrelations;
|
|
while (*ptr)
|
|
{
|
|
if (isdigit((unsigned char) *ptr))
|
|
{
|
|
int rti = strtol(ptr, &ptr, 10);
|
|
|
|
if (rti < minrti)
|
|
minrti = rti;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
ptr++;
|
|
}
|
|
rtoffset = bms_next_member(plan->fs_relids, -1) - minrti;
|
|
|
|
/* Now we can translate the string */
|
|
relations = makeStringInfo();
|
|
ptr = rawrelations;
|
|
while (*ptr)
|
|
{
|
|
if (isdigit((unsigned char) *ptr))
|
|
{
|
|
int rti = strtol(ptr, &ptr, 10);
|
|
RangeTblEntry *rte;
|
|
char *relname;
|
|
char *refname;
|
|
|
|
rti += rtoffset;
|
|
Assert(bms_is_member(rti, plan->fs_relids));
|
|
rte = rt_fetch(rti, es->rtable);
|
|
Assert(rte->rtekind == RTE_RELATION);
|
|
/* This logic should agree with explain.c's ExplainTargetRel */
|
|
relname = get_rel_name(rte->relid);
|
|
if (es->verbose)
|
|
{
|
|
char *namespace;
|
|
|
|
namespace = get_namespace_name_or_temp(get_rel_namespace(rte->relid));
|
|
appendStringInfo(relations, "%s.%s",
|
|
quote_identifier(namespace),
|
|
quote_identifier(relname));
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
appendStringInfoString(relations,
|
|
quote_identifier(relname));
|
|
refname = (char *) list_nth(es->rtable_names, rti - 1);
|
|
if (refname == NULL)
|
|
refname = rte->eref->aliasname;
|
|
if (strcmp(refname, relname) != 0)
|
|
appendStringInfo(relations, " %s",
|
|
quote_identifier(refname));
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
appendStringInfoChar(relations, *ptr++);
|
|
}
|
|
ExplainPropertyText("Relations", relations->data, es);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Add remote query, when VERBOSE option is specified.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (es->verbose)
|
|
{
|
|
char *sql;
|
|
|
|
sql = strVal(list_nth(fdw_private, FdwScanPrivateSelectSql));
|
|
ExplainPropertyText("Remote SQL", sql, es);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresExplainForeignModify
|
|
* Produce extra output for EXPLAIN of a ModifyTable on a foreign table
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
postgresExplainForeignModify(ModifyTableState *mtstate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *rinfo,
|
|
List *fdw_private,
|
|
int subplan_index,
|
|
ExplainState *es)
|
|
{
|
|
if (es->verbose)
|
|
{
|
|
char *sql = strVal(list_nth(fdw_private,
|
|
FdwModifyPrivateUpdateSql));
|
|
|
|
ExplainPropertyText("Remote SQL", sql, es);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* For INSERT we should always have batch size >= 1, but UPDATE and
|
|
* DELETE don't support batching so don't show the property.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (rinfo->ri_BatchSize > 0)
|
|
ExplainPropertyInteger("Batch Size", NULL, rinfo->ri_BatchSize, es);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresExplainDirectModify
|
|
* Produce extra output for EXPLAIN of a ForeignScan that modifies a
|
|
* foreign table directly
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
postgresExplainDirectModify(ForeignScanState *node, ExplainState *es)
|
|
{
|
|
List *fdw_private;
|
|
char *sql;
|
|
|
|
if (es->verbose)
|
|
{
|
|
fdw_private = ((ForeignScan *) node->ss.ps.plan)->fdw_private;
|
|
sql = strVal(list_nth(fdw_private, FdwDirectModifyPrivateUpdateSql));
|
|
ExplainPropertyText("Remote SQL", sql, es);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresExecForeignTruncate
|
|
* Truncate one or more foreign tables
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
postgresExecForeignTruncate(List *rels,
|
|
DropBehavior behavior,
|
|
bool restart_seqs)
|
|
{
|
|
Oid serverid = InvalidOid;
|
|
UserMapping *user = NULL;
|
|
PGconn *conn = NULL;
|
|
StringInfoData sql;
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
bool server_truncatable = true;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* By default, all postgres_fdw foreign tables are assumed truncatable.
|
|
* This can be overridden by a per-server setting, which in turn can be
|
|
* overridden by a per-table setting.
|
|
*/
|
|
foreach(lc, rels)
|
|
{
|
|
ForeignServer *server = NULL;
|
|
Relation rel = lfirst(lc);
|
|
ForeignTable *table = GetForeignTable(RelationGetRelid(rel));
|
|
ListCell *cell;
|
|
bool truncatable;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* First time through, determine whether the foreign server allows
|
|
* truncates. Since all specified foreign tables are assumed to belong
|
|
* to the same foreign server, this result can be used for other
|
|
* foreign tables.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!OidIsValid(serverid))
|
|
{
|
|
serverid = table->serverid;
|
|
server = GetForeignServer(serverid);
|
|
|
|
foreach(cell, server->options)
|
|
{
|
|
DefElem *defel = (DefElem *) lfirst(cell);
|
|
|
|
if (strcmp(defel->defname, "truncatable") == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
server_truncatable = defGetBoolean(defel);
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Confirm that all specified foreign tables belong to the same
|
|
* foreign server.
|
|
*/
|
|
Assert(table->serverid == serverid);
|
|
|
|
/* Determine whether this foreign table allows truncations */
|
|
truncatable = server_truncatable;
|
|
foreach(cell, table->options)
|
|
{
|
|
DefElem *defel = (DefElem *) lfirst(cell);
|
|
|
|
if (strcmp(defel->defname, "truncatable") == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
truncatable = defGetBoolean(defel);
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!truncatable)
|
|
ereport(ERROR,
|
|
(errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
|
|
errmsg("foreign table \"%s\" does not allow truncates",
|
|
RelationGetRelationName(rel))));
|
|
}
|
|
Assert(OidIsValid(serverid));
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Get connection to the foreign server. Connection manager will
|
|
* establish new connection if necessary.
|
|
*/
|
|
user = GetUserMapping(GetUserId(), serverid);
|
|
conn = GetConnection(user, false, NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* Construct the TRUNCATE command string */
|
|
initStringInfo(&sql);
|
|
deparseTruncateSql(&sql, rels, behavior, restart_seqs);
|
|
|
|
/* Issue the TRUNCATE command to remote server */
|
|
do_sql_command(conn, sql.data);
|
|
|
|
pfree(sql.data);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* estimate_path_cost_size
|
|
* Get cost and size estimates for a foreign scan on given foreign relation
|
|
* either a base relation or a join between foreign relations or an upper
|
|
* relation containing foreign relations.
|
|
*
|
|
* param_join_conds are the parameterization clauses with outer relations.
|
|
* pathkeys specify the expected sort order if any for given path being costed.
|
|
* fpextra specifies additional post-scan/join-processing steps such as the
|
|
* final sort and the LIMIT restriction.
|
|
*
|
|
* The function returns the cost and size estimates in p_rows, p_width,
|
|
* p_startup_cost and p_total_cost variables.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
estimate_path_cost_size(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
RelOptInfo *foreignrel,
|
|
List *param_join_conds,
|
|
List *pathkeys,
|
|
PgFdwPathExtraData *fpextra,
|
|
double *p_rows, int *p_width,
|
|
Cost *p_startup_cost, Cost *p_total_cost)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo = (PgFdwRelationInfo *) foreignrel->fdw_private;
|
|
double rows;
|
|
double retrieved_rows;
|
|
int width;
|
|
Cost startup_cost;
|
|
Cost total_cost;
|
|
|
|
/* Make sure the core code has set up the relation's reltarget */
|
|
Assert(foreignrel->reltarget);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If the table or the server is configured to use remote estimates,
|
|
* connect to the foreign server and execute EXPLAIN to estimate the
|
|
* number of rows selected by the restriction+join clauses. Otherwise,
|
|
* estimate rows using whatever statistics we have locally, in a way
|
|
* similar to ordinary tables.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fpinfo->use_remote_estimate)
|
|
{
|
|
List *remote_param_join_conds;
|
|
List *local_param_join_conds;
|
|
StringInfoData sql;
|
|
PGconn *conn;
|
|
Selectivity local_sel;
|
|
QualCost local_cost;
|
|
List *fdw_scan_tlist = NIL;
|
|
List *remote_conds;
|
|
|
|
/* Required only to be passed to deparseSelectStmtForRel */
|
|
List *retrieved_attrs;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* param_join_conds might contain both clauses that are safe to send
|
|
* across, and clauses that aren't.
|
|
*/
|
|
classifyConditions(root, foreignrel, param_join_conds,
|
|
&remote_param_join_conds, &local_param_join_conds);
|
|
|
|
/* Build the list of columns to be fetched from the foreign server. */
|
|
if (IS_JOIN_REL(foreignrel) || IS_UPPER_REL(foreignrel))
|
|
fdw_scan_tlist = build_tlist_to_deparse(foreignrel);
|
|
else
|
|
fdw_scan_tlist = NIL;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* The complete list of remote conditions includes everything from
|
|
* baserestrictinfo plus any extra join_conds relevant to this
|
|
* particular path.
|
|
*/
|
|
remote_conds = list_concat(remote_param_join_conds,
|
|
fpinfo->remote_conds);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Construct EXPLAIN query including the desired SELECT, FROM, and
|
|
* WHERE clauses. Params and other-relation Vars are replaced by dummy
|
|
* values, so don't request params_list.
|
|
*/
|
|
initStringInfo(&sql);
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&sql, "EXPLAIN ");
|
|
deparseSelectStmtForRel(&sql, root, foreignrel, fdw_scan_tlist,
|
|
remote_conds, pathkeys,
|
|
fpextra ? fpextra->has_final_sort : false,
|
|
fpextra ? fpextra->has_limit : false,
|
|
false, &retrieved_attrs, NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* Get the remote estimate */
|
|
conn = GetConnection(fpinfo->user, false, NULL);
|
|
get_remote_estimate(sql.data, conn, &rows, &width,
|
|
&startup_cost, &total_cost);
|
|
ReleaseConnection(conn);
|
|
|
|
retrieved_rows = rows;
|
|
|
|
/* Factor in the selectivity of the locally-checked quals */
|
|
local_sel = clauselist_selectivity(root,
|
|
local_param_join_conds,
|
|
foreignrel->relid,
|
|
JOIN_INNER,
|
|
NULL);
|
|
local_sel *= fpinfo->local_conds_sel;
|
|
|
|
rows = clamp_row_est(rows * local_sel);
|
|
|
|
/* Add in the eval cost of the locally-checked quals */
|
|
startup_cost += fpinfo->local_conds_cost.startup;
|
|
total_cost += fpinfo->local_conds_cost.per_tuple * retrieved_rows;
|
|
cost_qual_eval(&local_cost, local_param_join_conds, root);
|
|
startup_cost += local_cost.startup;
|
|
total_cost += local_cost.per_tuple * retrieved_rows;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Add in tlist eval cost for each output row. In case of an
|
|
* aggregate, some of the tlist expressions such as grouping
|
|
* expressions will be evaluated remotely, so adjust the costs.
|
|
*/
|
|
startup_cost += foreignrel->reltarget->cost.startup;
|
|
total_cost += foreignrel->reltarget->cost.startup;
|
|
total_cost += foreignrel->reltarget->cost.per_tuple * rows;
|
|
if (IS_UPPER_REL(foreignrel))
|
|
{
|
|
QualCost tlist_cost;
|
|
|
|
cost_qual_eval(&tlist_cost, fdw_scan_tlist, root);
|
|
startup_cost -= tlist_cost.startup;
|
|
total_cost -= tlist_cost.startup;
|
|
total_cost -= tlist_cost.per_tuple * rows;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
Cost run_cost = 0;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* We don't support join conditions in this mode (hence, no
|
|
* parameterized paths can be made).
|
|
*/
|
|
Assert(param_join_conds == NIL);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* We will come here again and again with different set of pathkeys or
|
|
* additional post-scan/join-processing steps that caller wants to
|
|
* cost. We don't need to calculate the cost/size estimates for the
|
|
* underlying scan, join, or grouping each time. Instead, use those
|
|
* estimates if we have cached them already.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fpinfo->rel_startup_cost >= 0 && fpinfo->rel_total_cost >= 0)
|
|
{
|
|
Assert(fpinfo->retrieved_rows >= 0);
|
|
|
|
rows = fpinfo->rows;
|
|
retrieved_rows = fpinfo->retrieved_rows;
|
|
width = fpinfo->width;
|
|
startup_cost = fpinfo->rel_startup_cost;
|
|
run_cost = fpinfo->rel_total_cost - fpinfo->rel_startup_cost;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If we estimate the costs of a foreign scan or a foreign join
|
|
* with additional post-scan/join-processing steps, the scan or
|
|
* join costs obtained from the cache wouldn't yet contain the
|
|
* eval costs for the final scan/join target, which would've been
|
|
* updated by apply_scanjoin_target_to_paths(); add the eval costs
|
|
* now.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fpextra && !IS_UPPER_REL(foreignrel))
|
|
{
|
|
/* Shouldn't get here unless we have LIMIT */
|
|
Assert(fpextra->has_limit);
|
|
Assert(foreignrel->reloptkind == RELOPT_BASEREL ||
|
|
foreignrel->reloptkind == RELOPT_JOINREL);
|
|
startup_cost += foreignrel->reltarget->cost.startup;
|
|
run_cost += foreignrel->reltarget->cost.per_tuple * rows;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if (IS_JOIN_REL(foreignrel))
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo_i;
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo_o;
|
|
QualCost join_cost;
|
|
QualCost remote_conds_cost;
|
|
double nrows;
|
|
|
|
/* Use rows/width estimates made by the core code. */
|
|
rows = foreignrel->rows;
|
|
width = foreignrel->reltarget->width;
|
|
|
|
/* For join we expect inner and outer relations set */
|
|
Assert(fpinfo->innerrel && fpinfo->outerrel);
|
|
|
|
fpinfo_i = (PgFdwRelationInfo *) fpinfo->innerrel->fdw_private;
|
|
fpinfo_o = (PgFdwRelationInfo *) fpinfo->outerrel->fdw_private;
|
|
|
|
/* Estimate of number of rows in cross product */
|
|
nrows = fpinfo_i->rows * fpinfo_o->rows;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Back into an estimate of the number of retrieved rows. Just in
|
|
* case this is nuts, clamp to at most nrows.
|
|
*/
|
|
retrieved_rows = clamp_row_est(rows / fpinfo->local_conds_sel);
|
|
retrieved_rows = Min(retrieved_rows, nrows);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* The cost of foreign join is estimated as cost of generating
|
|
* rows for the joining relations + cost for applying quals on the
|
|
* rows.
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Calculate the cost of clauses pushed down to the foreign server
|
|
*/
|
|
cost_qual_eval(&remote_conds_cost, fpinfo->remote_conds, root);
|
|
/* Calculate the cost of applying join clauses */
|
|
cost_qual_eval(&join_cost, fpinfo->joinclauses, root);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Startup cost includes startup cost of joining relations and the
|
|
* startup cost for join and other clauses. We do not include the
|
|
* startup cost specific to join strategy (e.g. setting up hash
|
|
* tables) since we do not know what strategy the foreign server
|
|
* is going to use.
|
|
*/
|
|
startup_cost = fpinfo_i->rel_startup_cost + fpinfo_o->rel_startup_cost;
|
|
startup_cost += join_cost.startup;
|
|
startup_cost += remote_conds_cost.startup;
|
|
startup_cost += fpinfo->local_conds_cost.startup;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Run time cost includes:
|
|
*
|
|
* 1. Run time cost (total_cost - startup_cost) of relations being
|
|
* joined
|
|
*
|
|
* 2. Run time cost of applying join clauses on the cross product
|
|
* of the joining relations.
|
|
*
|
|
* 3. Run time cost of applying pushed down other clauses on the
|
|
* result of join
|
|
*
|
|
* 4. Run time cost of applying nonpushable other clauses locally
|
|
* on the result fetched from the foreign server.
|
|
*/
|
|
run_cost = fpinfo_i->rel_total_cost - fpinfo_i->rel_startup_cost;
|
|
run_cost += fpinfo_o->rel_total_cost - fpinfo_o->rel_startup_cost;
|
|
run_cost += nrows * join_cost.per_tuple;
|
|
nrows = clamp_row_est(nrows * fpinfo->joinclause_sel);
|
|
run_cost += nrows * remote_conds_cost.per_tuple;
|
|
run_cost += fpinfo->local_conds_cost.per_tuple * retrieved_rows;
|
|
|
|
/* Add in tlist eval cost for each output row */
|
|
startup_cost += foreignrel->reltarget->cost.startup;
|
|
run_cost += foreignrel->reltarget->cost.per_tuple * rows;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (IS_UPPER_REL(foreignrel))
|
|
{
|
|
RelOptInfo *outerrel = fpinfo->outerrel;
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *ofpinfo;
|
|
AggClauseCosts aggcosts;
|
|
double input_rows;
|
|
int numGroupCols;
|
|
double numGroups = 1;
|
|
|
|
/* The upper relation should have its outer relation set */
|
|
Assert(outerrel);
|
|
/* and that outer relation should have its reltarget set */
|
|
Assert(outerrel->reltarget);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* This cost model is mixture of costing done for sorted and
|
|
* hashed aggregates in cost_agg(). We are not sure which
|
|
* strategy will be considered at remote side, thus for
|
|
* simplicity, we put all startup related costs in startup_cost
|
|
* and all finalization and run cost are added in total_cost.
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
ofpinfo = (PgFdwRelationInfo *) outerrel->fdw_private;
|
|
|
|
/* Get rows from input rel */
|
|
input_rows = ofpinfo->rows;
|
|
|
|
/* Collect statistics about aggregates for estimating costs. */
|
|
MemSet(&aggcosts, 0, sizeof(AggClauseCosts));
|
|
if (root->parse->hasAggs)
|
|
{
|
|
get_agg_clause_costs(root, AGGSPLIT_SIMPLE, &aggcosts);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Get number of grouping columns and possible number of groups */
|
|
numGroupCols = list_length(root->parse->groupClause);
|
|
numGroups = estimate_num_groups(root,
|
|
get_sortgrouplist_exprs(root->parse->groupClause,
|
|
fpinfo->grouped_tlist),
|
|
input_rows, NULL, NULL);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Get the retrieved_rows and rows estimates. If there are HAVING
|
|
* quals, account for their selectivity.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (root->parse->havingQual)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Factor in the selectivity of the remotely-checked quals */
|
|
retrieved_rows =
|
|
clamp_row_est(numGroups *
|
|
clauselist_selectivity(root,
|
|
fpinfo->remote_conds,
|
|
0,
|
|
JOIN_INNER,
|
|
NULL));
|
|
/* Factor in the selectivity of the locally-checked quals */
|
|
rows = clamp_row_est(retrieved_rows * fpinfo->local_conds_sel);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
rows = retrieved_rows = numGroups;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Use width estimate made by the core code. */
|
|
width = foreignrel->reltarget->width;
|
|
|
|
/*-----
|
|
* Startup cost includes:
|
|
* 1. Startup cost for underneath input relation, adjusted for
|
|
* tlist replacement by apply_scanjoin_target_to_paths()
|
|
* 2. Cost of performing aggregation, per cost_agg()
|
|
*-----
|
|
*/
|
|
startup_cost = ofpinfo->rel_startup_cost;
|
|
startup_cost += outerrel->reltarget->cost.startup;
|
|
startup_cost += aggcosts.transCost.startup;
|
|
startup_cost += aggcosts.transCost.per_tuple * input_rows;
|
|
startup_cost += aggcosts.finalCost.startup;
|
|
startup_cost += (cpu_operator_cost * numGroupCols) * input_rows;
|
|
|
|
/*-----
|
|
* Run time cost includes:
|
|
* 1. Run time cost of underneath input relation, adjusted for
|
|
* tlist replacement by apply_scanjoin_target_to_paths()
|
|
* 2. Run time cost of performing aggregation, per cost_agg()
|
|
*-----
|
|
*/
|
|
run_cost = ofpinfo->rel_total_cost - ofpinfo->rel_startup_cost;
|
|
run_cost += outerrel->reltarget->cost.per_tuple * input_rows;
|
|
run_cost += aggcosts.finalCost.per_tuple * numGroups;
|
|
run_cost += cpu_tuple_cost * numGroups;
|
|
|
|
/* Account for the eval cost of HAVING quals, if any */
|
|
if (root->parse->havingQual)
|
|
{
|
|
QualCost remote_cost;
|
|
|
|
/* Add in the eval cost of the remotely-checked quals */
|
|
cost_qual_eval(&remote_cost, fpinfo->remote_conds, root);
|
|
startup_cost += remote_cost.startup;
|
|
run_cost += remote_cost.per_tuple * numGroups;
|
|
/* Add in the eval cost of the locally-checked quals */
|
|
startup_cost += fpinfo->local_conds_cost.startup;
|
|
run_cost += fpinfo->local_conds_cost.per_tuple * retrieved_rows;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Add in tlist eval cost for each output row */
|
|
startup_cost += foreignrel->reltarget->cost.startup;
|
|
run_cost += foreignrel->reltarget->cost.per_tuple * rows;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
Cost cpu_per_tuple;
|
|
|
|
/* Use rows/width estimates made by set_baserel_size_estimates. */
|
|
rows = foreignrel->rows;
|
|
width = foreignrel->reltarget->width;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Back into an estimate of the number of retrieved rows. Just in
|
|
* case this is nuts, clamp to at most foreignrel->tuples.
|
|
*/
|
|
retrieved_rows = clamp_row_est(rows / fpinfo->local_conds_sel);
|
|
retrieved_rows = Min(retrieved_rows, foreignrel->tuples);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Cost as though this were a seqscan, which is pessimistic. We
|
|
* effectively imagine the local_conds are being evaluated
|
|
* remotely, too.
|
|
*/
|
|
startup_cost = 0;
|
|
run_cost = 0;
|
|
run_cost += seq_page_cost * foreignrel->pages;
|
|
|
|
startup_cost += foreignrel->baserestrictcost.startup;
|
|
cpu_per_tuple = cpu_tuple_cost + foreignrel->baserestrictcost.per_tuple;
|
|
run_cost += cpu_per_tuple * foreignrel->tuples;
|
|
|
|
/* Add in tlist eval cost for each output row */
|
|
startup_cost += foreignrel->reltarget->cost.startup;
|
|
run_cost += foreignrel->reltarget->cost.per_tuple * rows;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Without remote estimates, we have no real way to estimate the cost
|
|
* of generating sorted output. It could be free if the query plan
|
|
* the remote side would have chosen generates properly-sorted output
|
|
* anyway, but in most cases it will cost something. Estimate a value
|
|
* high enough that we won't pick the sorted path when the ordering
|
|
* isn't locally useful, but low enough that we'll err on the side of
|
|
* pushing down the ORDER BY clause when it's useful to do so.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (pathkeys != NIL)
|
|
{
|
|
if (IS_UPPER_REL(foreignrel))
|
|
{
|
|
Assert(foreignrel->reloptkind == RELOPT_UPPER_REL &&
|
|
fpinfo->stage == UPPERREL_GROUP_AGG);
|
|
adjust_foreign_grouping_path_cost(root, pathkeys,
|
|
retrieved_rows, width,
|
|
fpextra->limit_tuples,
|
|
&startup_cost, &run_cost);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
startup_cost *= DEFAULT_FDW_SORT_MULTIPLIER;
|
|
run_cost *= DEFAULT_FDW_SORT_MULTIPLIER;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
total_cost = startup_cost + run_cost;
|
|
|
|
/* Adjust the cost estimates if we have LIMIT */
|
|
if (fpextra && fpextra->has_limit)
|
|
{
|
|
adjust_limit_rows_costs(&rows, &startup_cost, &total_cost,
|
|
fpextra->offset_est, fpextra->count_est);
|
|
retrieved_rows = rows;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If this includes the final sort step, the given target, which will be
|
|
* applied to the resulting path, might have different expressions from
|
|
* the foreignrel's reltarget (see make_sort_input_target()); adjust tlist
|
|
* eval costs.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fpextra && fpextra->has_final_sort &&
|
|
fpextra->target != foreignrel->reltarget)
|
|
{
|
|
QualCost oldcost = foreignrel->reltarget->cost;
|
|
QualCost newcost = fpextra->target->cost;
|
|
|
|
startup_cost += newcost.startup - oldcost.startup;
|
|
total_cost += newcost.startup - oldcost.startup;
|
|
total_cost += (newcost.per_tuple - oldcost.per_tuple) * rows;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Cache the retrieved rows and cost estimates for scans, joins, or
|
|
* groupings without any parameterization, pathkeys, or additional
|
|
* post-scan/join-processing steps, before adding the costs for
|
|
* transferring data from the foreign server. These estimates are useful
|
|
* for costing remote joins involving this relation or costing other
|
|
* remote operations on this relation such as remote sorts and remote
|
|
* LIMIT restrictions, when the costs can not be obtained from the foreign
|
|
* server. This function will be called at least once for every foreign
|
|
* relation without any parameterization, pathkeys, or additional
|
|
* post-scan/join-processing steps.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (pathkeys == NIL && param_join_conds == NIL && fpextra == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
fpinfo->retrieved_rows = retrieved_rows;
|
|
fpinfo->rel_startup_cost = startup_cost;
|
|
fpinfo->rel_total_cost = total_cost;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Add some additional cost factors to account for connection overhead
|
|
* (fdw_startup_cost), transferring data across the network
|
|
* (fdw_tuple_cost per retrieved row), and local manipulation of the data
|
|
* (cpu_tuple_cost per retrieved row).
|
|
*/
|
|
startup_cost += fpinfo->fdw_startup_cost;
|
|
total_cost += fpinfo->fdw_startup_cost;
|
|
total_cost += fpinfo->fdw_tuple_cost * retrieved_rows;
|
|
total_cost += cpu_tuple_cost * retrieved_rows;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If we have LIMIT, we should prefer performing the restriction remotely
|
|
* rather than locally, as the former avoids extra row fetches from the
|
|
* remote that the latter might cause. But since the core code doesn't
|
|
* account for such fetches when estimating the costs of the local
|
|
* restriction (see create_limit_path()), there would be no difference
|
|
* between the costs of the local restriction and the costs of the remote
|
|
* restriction estimated above if we don't use remote estimates (except
|
|
* for the case where the foreignrel is a grouping relation, the given
|
|
* pathkeys is not NIL, and the effects of a bounded sort for that rel is
|
|
* accounted for in costing the remote restriction). Tweak the costs of
|
|
* the remote restriction to ensure we'll prefer it if LIMIT is a useful
|
|
* one.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!fpinfo->use_remote_estimate &&
|
|
fpextra && fpextra->has_limit &&
|
|
fpextra->limit_tuples > 0 &&
|
|
fpextra->limit_tuples < fpinfo->rows)
|
|
{
|
|
Assert(fpinfo->rows > 0);
|
|
total_cost -= (total_cost - startup_cost) * 0.05 *
|
|
(fpinfo->rows - fpextra->limit_tuples) / fpinfo->rows;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return results. */
|
|
*p_rows = rows;
|
|
*p_width = width;
|
|
*p_startup_cost = startup_cost;
|
|
*p_total_cost = total_cost;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Estimate costs of executing a SQL statement remotely.
|
|
* The given "sql" must be an EXPLAIN command.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
get_remote_estimate(const char *sql, PGconn *conn,
|
|
double *rows, int *width,
|
|
Cost *startup_cost, Cost *total_cost)
|
|
{
|
|
PGresult *volatile res = NULL;
|
|
|
|
/* PGresult must be released before leaving this function. */
|
|
PG_TRY();
|
|
{
|
|
char *line;
|
|
char *p;
|
|
int n;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Execute EXPLAIN remotely.
|
|
*/
|
|
res = pgfdw_exec_query(conn, sql, NULL);
|
|
if (PQresultStatus(res) != PGRES_TUPLES_OK)
|
|
pgfdw_report_error(ERROR, res, conn, false, sql);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Extract cost numbers for topmost plan node. Note we search for a
|
|
* left paren from the end of the line to avoid being confused by
|
|
* other uses of parentheses.
|
|
*/
|
|
line = PQgetvalue(res, 0, 0);
|
|
p = strrchr(line, '(');
|
|
if (p == NULL)
|
|
elog(ERROR, "could not interpret EXPLAIN output: \"%s\"", line);
|
|
n = sscanf(p, "(cost=%lf..%lf rows=%lf width=%d)",
|
|
startup_cost, total_cost, rows, width);
|
|
if (n != 4)
|
|
elog(ERROR, "could not interpret EXPLAIN output: \"%s\"", line);
|
|
}
|
|
PG_FINALLY();
|
|
{
|
|
if (res)
|
|
PQclear(res);
|
|
}
|
|
PG_END_TRY();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Adjust the cost estimates of a foreign grouping path to include the cost of
|
|
* generating properly-sorted output.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
adjust_foreign_grouping_path_cost(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
List *pathkeys,
|
|
double retrieved_rows,
|
|
double width,
|
|
double limit_tuples,
|
|
Cost *p_startup_cost,
|
|
Cost *p_run_cost)
|
|
{
|
|
/*
|
|
* If the GROUP BY clause isn't sort-able, the plan chosen by the remote
|
|
* side is unlikely to generate properly-sorted output, so it would need
|
|
* an explicit sort; adjust the given costs with cost_sort(). Likewise,
|
|
* if the GROUP BY clause is sort-able but isn't a superset of the given
|
|
* pathkeys, adjust the costs with that function. Otherwise, adjust the
|
|
* costs by applying the same heuristic as for the scan or join case.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!grouping_is_sortable(root->parse->groupClause) ||
|
|
!pathkeys_contained_in(pathkeys, root->group_pathkeys))
|
|
{
|
|
Path sort_path; /* dummy for result of cost_sort */
|
|
|
|
cost_sort(&sort_path,
|
|
root,
|
|
pathkeys,
|
|
*p_startup_cost + *p_run_cost,
|
|
retrieved_rows,
|
|
width,
|
|
0.0,
|
|
work_mem,
|
|
limit_tuples);
|
|
|
|
*p_startup_cost = sort_path.startup_cost;
|
|
*p_run_cost = sort_path.total_cost - sort_path.startup_cost;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/*
|
|
* The default extra cost seems too large for foreign-grouping cases;
|
|
* add 1/4th of that default.
|
|
*/
|
|
double sort_multiplier = 1.0 + (DEFAULT_FDW_SORT_MULTIPLIER
|
|
- 1.0) * 0.25;
|
|
|
|
*p_startup_cost *= sort_multiplier;
|
|
*p_run_cost *= sort_multiplier;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Detect whether we want to process an EquivalenceClass member.
|
|
*
|
|
* This is a callback for use by generate_implied_equalities_for_column.
|
|
*/
|
|
static bool
|
|
ec_member_matches_foreign(PlannerInfo *root, RelOptInfo *rel,
|
|
EquivalenceClass *ec, EquivalenceMember *em,
|
|
void *arg)
|
|
{
|
|
ec_member_foreign_arg *state = (ec_member_foreign_arg *) arg;
|
|
Expr *expr = em->em_expr;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If we've identified what we're processing in the current scan, we only
|
|
* want to match that expression.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (state->current != NULL)
|
|
return equal(expr, state->current);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Otherwise, ignore anything we've already processed.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (list_member(state->already_used, expr))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
/* This is the new target to process. */
|
|
state->current = expr;
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Create cursor for node's query with current parameter values.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
create_cursor(ForeignScanState *node)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwScanState *fsstate = (PgFdwScanState *) node->fdw_state;
|
|
ExprContext *econtext = node->ss.ps.ps_ExprContext;
|
|
int numParams = fsstate->numParams;
|
|
const char **values = fsstate->param_values;
|
|
PGconn *conn = fsstate->conn;
|
|
StringInfoData buf;
|
|
PGresult *res;
|
|
|
|
/* First, process a pending asynchronous request, if any. */
|
|
if (fsstate->conn_state->pendingAreq)
|
|
process_pending_request(fsstate->conn_state->pendingAreq);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Construct array of query parameter values in text format. We do the
|
|
* conversions in the short-lived per-tuple context, so as not to cause a
|
|
* memory leak over repeated scans.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (numParams > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
MemoryContext oldcontext;
|
|
|
|
oldcontext = MemoryContextSwitchTo(econtext->ecxt_per_tuple_memory);
|
|
|
|
process_query_params(econtext,
|
|
fsstate->param_flinfo,
|
|
fsstate->param_exprs,
|
|
values);
|
|
|
|
MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldcontext);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Construct the DECLARE CURSOR command */
|
|
initStringInfo(&buf);
|
|
appendStringInfo(&buf, "DECLARE c%u CURSOR FOR\n%s",
|
|
fsstate->cursor_number, fsstate->query);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Notice that we pass NULL for paramTypes, thus forcing the remote server
|
|
* to infer types for all parameters. Since we explicitly cast every
|
|
* parameter (see deparse.c), the "inference" is trivial and will produce
|
|
* the desired result. This allows us to avoid assuming that the remote
|
|
* server has the same OIDs we do for the parameters' types.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!PQsendQueryParams(conn, buf.data, numParams,
|
|
NULL, values, NULL, NULL, 0))
|
|
pgfdw_report_error(ERROR, NULL, conn, false, buf.data);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Get the result, and check for success.
|
|
*
|
|
* We don't use a PG_TRY block here, so be careful not to throw error
|
|
* without releasing the PGresult.
|
|
*/
|
|
res = pgfdw_get_result(conn, buf.data);
|
|
if (PQresultStatus(res) != PGRES_COMMAND_OK)
|
|
pgfdw_report_error(ERROR, res, conn, true, fsstate->query);
|
|
PQclear(res);
|
|
|
|
/* Mark the cursor as created, and show no tuples have been retrieved */
|
|
fsstate->cursor_exists = true;
|
|
fsstate->tuples = NULL;
|
|
fsstate->num_tuples = 0;
|
|
fsstate->next_tuple = 0;
|
|
fsstate->fetch_ct_2 = 0;
|
|
fsstate->eof_reached = false;
|
|
|
|
/* Clean up */
|
|
pfree(buf.data);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Fetch some more rows from the node's cursor.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
fetch_more_data(ForeignScanState *node)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwScanState *fsstate = (PgFdwScanState *) node->fdw_state;
|
|
PGresult *volatile res = NULL;
|
|
MemoryContext oldcontext;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* We'll store the tuples in the batch_cxt. First, flush the previous
|
|
* batch.
|
|
*/
|
|
fsstate->tuples = NULL;
|
|
MemoryContextReset(fsstate->batch_cxt);
|
|
oldcontext = MemoryContextSwitchTo(fsstate->batch_cxt);
|
|
|
|
/* PGresult must be released before leaving this function. */
|
|
PG_TRY();
|
|
{
|
|
PGconn *conn = fsstate->conn;
|
|
int numrows;
|
|
int i;
|
|
|
|
if (fsstate->async_capable)
|
|
{
|
|
Assert(fsstate->conn_state->pendingAreq);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* The query was already sent by an earlier call to
|
|
* fetch_more_data_begin. So now we just fetch the result.
|
|
*/
|
|
res = pgfdw_get_result(conn, fsstate->query);
|
|
/* On error, report the original query, not the FETCH. */
|
|
if (PQresultStatus(res) != PGRES_TUPLES_OK)
|
|
pgfdw_report_error(ERROR, res, conn, false, fsstate->query);
|
|
|
|
/* Reset per-connection state */
|
|
fsstate->conn_state->pendingAreq = NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
char sql[64];
|
|
|
|
/* This is a regular synchronous fetch. */
|
|
snprintf(sql, sizeof(sql), "FETCH %d FROM c%u",
|
|
fsstate->fetch_size, fsstate->cursor_number);
|
|
|
|
res = pgfdw_exec_query(conn, sql, fsstate->conn_state);
|
|
/* On error, report the original query, not the FETCH. */
|
|
if (PQresultStatus(res) != PGRES_TUPLES_OK)
|
|
pgfdw_report_error(ERROR, res, conn, false, fsstate->query);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Convert the data into HeapTuples */
|
|
numrows = PQntuples(res);
|
|
fsstate->tuples = (HeapTuple *) palloc0(numrows * sizeof(HeapTuple));
|
|
fsstate->num_tuples = numrows;
|
|
fsstate->next_tuple = 0;
|
|
|
|
for (i = 0; i < numrows; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
Assert(IsA(node->ss.ps.plan, ForeignScan));
|
|
|
|
fsstate->tuples[i] =
|
|
make_tuple_from_result_row(res, i,
|
|
fsstate->rel,
|
|
fsstate->attinmeta,
|
|
fsstate->retrieved_attrs,
|
|
node,
|
|
fsstate->temp_cxt);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Update fetch_ct_2 */
|
|
if (fsstate->fetch_ct_2 < 2)
|
|
fsstate->fetch_ct_2++;
|
|
|
|
/* Must be EOF if we didn't get as many tuples as we asked for. */
|
|
fsstate->eof_reached = (numrows < fsstate->fetch_size);
|
|
}
|
|
PG_FINALLY();
|
|
{
|
|
if (res)
|
|
PQclear(res);
|
|
}
|
|
PG_END_TRY();
|
|
|
|
MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldcontext);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Force assorted GUC parameters to settings that ensure that we'll output
|
|
* data values in a form that is unambiguous to the remote server.
|
|
*
|
|
* This is rather expensive and annoying to do once per row, but there's
|
|
* little choice if we want to be sure values are transmitted accurately;
|
|
* we can't leave the settings in place between rows for fear of affecting
|
|
* user-visible computations.
|
|
*
|
|
* We use the equivalent of a function SET option to allow the settings to
|
|
* persist only until the caller calls reset_transmission_modes(). If an
|
|
* error is thrown in between, guc.c will take care of undoing the settings.
|
|
*
|
|
* The return value is the nestlevel that must be passed to
|
|
* reset_transmission_modes() to undo things.
|
|
*/
|
|
int
|
|
set_transmission_modes(void)
|
|
{
|
|
int nestlevel = NewGUCNestLevel();
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* The values set here should match what pg_dump does. See also
|
|
* configure_remote_session in connection.c.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (DateStyle != USE_ISO_DATES)
|
|
(void) set_config_option("datestyle", "ISO",
|
|
PGC_USERSET, PGC_S_SESSION,
|
|
GUC_ACTION_SAVE, true, 0, false);
|
|
if (IntervalStyle != INTSTYLE_POSTGRES)
|
|
(void) set_config_option("intervalstyle", "postgres",
|
|
PGC_USERSET, PGC_S_SESSION,
|
|
GUC_ACTION_SAVE, true, 0, false);
|
|
if (extra_float_digits < 3)
|
|
(void) set_config_option("extra_float_digits", "3",
|
|
PGC_USERSET, PGC_S_SESSION,
|
|
GUC_ACTION_SAVE, true, 0, false);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* In addition force restrictive search_path, in case there are any
|
|
* regproc or similar constants to be printed.
|
|
*/
|
|
(void) set_config_option("search_path", "pg_catalog",
|
|
PGC_USERSET, PGC_S_SESSION,
|
|
GUC_ACTION_SAVE, true, 0, false);
|
|
|
|
return nestlevel;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Undo the effects of set_transmission_modes().
|
|
*/
|
|
void
|
|
reset_transmission_modes(int nestlevel)
|
|
{
|
|
AtEOXact_GUC(true, nestlevel);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Utility routine to close a cursor.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
close_cursor(PGconn *conn, unsigned int cursor_number,
|
|
PgFdwConnState *conn_state)
|
|
{
|
|
char sql[64];
|
|
PGresult *res;
|
|
|
|
snprintf(sql, sizeof(sql), "CLOSE c%u", cursor_number);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* We don't use a PG_TRY block here, so be careful not to throw error
|
|
* without releasing the PGresult.
|
|
*/
|
|
res = pgfdw_exec_query(conn, sql, conn_state);
|
|
if (PQresultStatus(res) != PGRES_COMMAND_OK)
|
|
pgfdw_report_error(ERROR, res, conn, true, sql);
|
|
PQclear(res);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* create_foreign_modify
|
|
* Construct an execution state of a foreign insert/update/delete
|
|
* operation
|
|
*/
|
|
static PgFdwModifyState *
|
|
create_foreign_modify(EState *estate,
|
|
RangeTblEntry *rte,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo,
|
|
CmdType operation,
|
|
Plan *subplan,
|
|
char *query,
|
|
List *target_attrs,
|
|
int values_end,
|
|
bool has_returning,
|
|
List *retrieved_attrs)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwModifyState *fmstate;
|
|
Relation rel = resultRelInfo->ri_RelationDesc;
|
|
TupleDesc tupdesc = RelationGetDescr(rel);
|
|
Oid userid;
|
|
ForeignTable *table;
|
|
UserMapping *user;
|
|
AttrNumber n_params;
|
|
Oid typefnoid;
|
|
bool isvarlena;
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
/* Begin constructing PgFdwModifyState. */
|
|
fmstate = (PgFdwModifyState *) palloc0(sizeof(PgFdwModifyState));
|
|
fmstate->rel = rel;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Identify which user to do the remote access as. This should match what
|
|
* ExecCheckRTEPerms() does.
|
|
*/
|
|
userid = rte->checkAsUser ? rte->checkAsUser : GetUserId();
|
|
|
|
/* Get info about foreign table. */
|
|
table = GetForeignTable(RelationGetRelid(rel));
|
|
user = GetUserMapping(userid, table->serverid);
|
|
|
|
/* Open connection; report that we'll create a prepared statement. */
|
|
fmstate->conn = GetConnection(user, true, &fmstate->conn_state);
|
|
fmstate->p_name = NULL; /* prepared statement not made yet */
|
|
|
|
/* Set up remote query information. */
|
|
fmstate->query = query;
|
|
if (operation == CMD_INSERT)
|
|
{
|
|
fmstate->query = pstrdup(fmstate->query);
|
|
fmstate->orig_query = pstrdup(fmstate->query);
|
|
}
|
|
fmstate->target_attrs = target_attrs;
|
|
fmstate->values_end = values_end;
|
|
fmstate->has_returning = has_returning;
|
|
fmstate->retrieved_attrs = retrieved_attrs;
|
|
|
|
/* Create context for per-tuple temp workspace. */
|
|
fmstate->temp_cxt = AllocSetContextCreate(estate->es_query_cxt,
|
|
"postgres_fdw temporary data",
|
|
ALLOCSET_SMALL_SIZES);
|
|
|
|
/* Prepare for input conversion of RETURNING results. */
|
|
if (fmstate->has_returning)
|
|
fmstate->attinmeta = TupleDescGetAttInMetadata(tupdesc);
|
|
|
|
/* Prepare for output conversion of parameters used in prepared stmt. */
|
|
n_params = list_length(fmstate->target_attrs) + 1;
|
|
fmstate->p_flinfo = (FmgrInfo *) palloc0(sizeof(FmgrInfo) * n_params);
|
|
fmstate->p_nums = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (operation == CMD_UPDATE || operation == CMD_DELETE)
|
|
{
|
|
Assert(subplan != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* Find the ctid resjunk column in the subplan's result */
|
|
fmstate->ctidAttno = ExecFindJunkAttributeInTlist(subplan->targetlist,
|
|
"ctid");
|
|
if (!AttributeNumberIsValid(fmstate->ctidAttno))
|
|
elog(ERROR, "could not find junk ctid column");
|
|
|
|
/* First transmittable parameter will be ctid */
|
|
getTypeOutputInfo(TIDOID, &typefnoid, &isvarlena);
|
|
fmgr_info(typefnoid, &fmstate->p_flinfo[fmstate->p_nums]);
|
|
fmstate->p_nums++;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (operation == CMD_INSERT || operation == CMD_UPDATE)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Set up for remaining transmittable parameters */
|
|
foreach(lc, fmstate->target_attrs)
|
|
{
|
|
int attnum = lfirst_int(lc);
|
|
Form_pg_attribute attr = TupleDescAttr(tupdesc, attnum - 1);
|
|
|
|
Assert(!attr->attisdropped);
|
|
|
|
/* Ignore generated columns; they are set to DEFAULT */
|
|
if (attr->attgenerated)
|
|
continue;
|
|
getTypeOutputInfo(attr->atttypid, &typefnoid, &isvarlena);
|
|
fmgr_info(typefnoid, &fmstate->p_flinfo[fmstate->p_nums]);
|
|
fmstate->p_nums++;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Assert(fmstate->p_nums <= n_params);
|
|
|
|
/* Set batch_size from foreign server/table options. */
|
|
if (operation == CMD_INSERT)
|
|
fmstate->batch_size = get_batch_size_option(rel);
|
|
|
|
fmstate->num_slots = 1;
|
|
|
|
/* Initialize auxiliary state */
|
|
fmstate->aux_fmstate = NULL;
|
|
|
|
return fmstate;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* execute_foreign_modify
|
|
* Perform foreign-table modification as required, and fetch RETURNING
|
|
* result if any. (This is the shared guts of postgresExecForeignInsert,
|
|
* postgresExecForeignBatchInsert, postgresExecForeignUpdate, and
|
|
* postgresExecForeignDelete.)
|
|
*/
|
|
static TupleTableSlot **
|
|
execute_foreign_modify(EState *estate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo,
|
|
CmdType operation,
|
|
TupleTableSlot **slots,
|
|
TupleTableSlot **planSlots,
|
|
int *numSlots)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwModifyState *fmstate = (PgFdwModifyState *) resultRelInfo->ri_FdwState;
|
|
ItemPointer ctid = NULL;
|
|
const char **p_values;
|
|
PGresult *res;
|
|
int n_rows;
|
|
StringInfoData sql;
|
|
|
|
/* The operation should be INSERT, UPDATE, or DELETE */
|
|
Assert(operation == CMD_INSERT ||
|
|
operation == CMD_UPDATE ||
|
|
operation == CMD_DELETE);
|
|
|
|
/* First, process a pending asynchronous request, if any. */
|
|
if (fmstate->conn_state->pendingAreq)
|
|
process_pending_request(fmstate->conn_state->pendingAreq);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If the existing query was deparsed and prepared for a different number
|
|
* of rows, rebuild it for the proper number.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (operation == CMD_INSERT && fmstate->num_slots != *numSlots)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Destroy the prepared statement created previously */
|
|
if (fmstate->p_name)
|
|
deallocate_query(fmstate);
|
|
|
|
/* Build INSERT string with numSlots records in its VALUES clause. */
|
|
initStringInfo(&sql);
|
|
rebuildInsertSql(&sql, fmstate->rel,
|
|
fmstate->orig_query, fmstate->target_attrs,
|
|
fmstate->values_end, fmstate->p_nums,
|
|
*numSlots - 1);
|
|
pfree(fmstate->query);
|
|
fmstate->query = sql.data;
|
|
fmstate->num_slots = *numSlots;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Set up the prepared statement on the remote server, if we didn't yet */
|
|
if (!fmstate->p_name)
|
|
prepare_foreign_modify(fmstate);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* For UPDATE/DELETE, get the ctid that was passed up as a resjunk column
|
|
*/
|
|
if (operation == CMD_UPDATE || operation == CMD_DELETE)
|
|
{
|
|
Datum datum;
|
|
bool isNull;
|
|
|
|
datum = ExecGetJunkAttribute(planSlots[0],
|
|
fmstate->ctidAttno,
|
|
&isNull);
|
|
/* shouldn't ever get a null result... */
|
|
if (isNull)
|
|
elog(ERROR, "ctid is NULL");
|
|
ctid = (ItemPointer) DatumGetPointer(datum);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Convert parameters needed by prepared statement to text form */
|
|
p_values = convert_prep_stmt_params(fmstate, ctid, slots, *numSlots);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Execute the prepared statement.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!PQsendQueryPrepared(fmstate->conn,
|
|
fmstate->p_name,
|
|
fmstate->p_nums * (*numSlots),
|
|
p_values,
|
|
NULL,
|
|
NULL,
|
|
0))
|
|
pgfdw_report_error(ERROR, NULL, fmstate->conn, false, fmstate->query);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Get the result, and check for success.
|
|
*
|
|
* We don't use a PG_TRY block here, so be careful not to throw error
|
|
* without releasing the PGresult.
|
|
*/
|
|
res = pgfdw_get_result(fmstate->conn, fmstate->query);
|
|
if (PQresultStatus(res) !=
|
|
(fmstate->has_returning ? PGRES_TUPLES_OK : PGRES_COMMAND_OK))
|
|
pgfdw_report_error(ERROR, res, fmstate->conn, true, fmstate->query);
|
|
|
|
/* Check number of rows affected, and fetch RETURNING tuple if any */
|
|
if (fmstate->has_returning)
|
|
{
|
|
Assert(*numSlots == 1);
|
|
n_rows = PQntuples(res);
|
|
if (n_rows > 0)
|
|
store_returning_result(fmstate, slots[0], res);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
n_rows = atoi(PQcmdTuples(res));
|
|
|
|
/* And clean up */
|
|
PQclear(res);
|
|
|
|
MemoryContextReset(fmstate->temp_cxt);
|
|
|
|
*numSlots = n_rows;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Return NULL if nothing was inserted/updated/deleted on the remote end
|
|
*/
|
|
return (n_rows > 0) ? slots : NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* prepare_foreign_modify
|
|
* Establish a prepared statement for execution of INSERT/UPDATE/DELETE
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
prepare_foreign_modify(PgFdwModifyState *fmstate)
|
|
{
|
|
char prep_name[NAMEDATALEN];
|
|
char *p_name;
|
|
PGresult *res;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* The caller would already have processed a pending asynchronous request
|
|
* if any, so no need to do it here.
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
/* Construct name we'll use for the prepared statement. */
|
|
snprintf(prep_name, sizeof(prep_name), "pgsql_fdw_prep_%u",
|
|
GetPrepStmtNumber(fmstate->conn));
|
|
p_name = pstrdup(prep_name);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* We intentionally do not specify parameter types here, but leave the
|
|
* remote server to derive them by default. This avoids possible problems
|
|
* with the remote server using different type OIDs than we do. All of
|
|
* the prepared statements we use in this module are simple enough that
|
|
* the remote server will make the right choices.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!PQsendPrepare(fmstate->conn,
|
|
p_name,
|
|
fmstate->query,
|
|
0,
|
|
NULL))
|
|
pgfdw_report_error(ERROR, NULL, fmstate->conn, false, fmstate->query);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Get the result, and check for success.
|
|
*
|
|
* We don't use a PG_TRY block here, so be careful not to throw error
|
|
* without releasing the PGresult.
|
|
*/
|
|
res = pgfdw_get_result(fmstate->conn, fmstate->query);
|
|
if (PQresultStatus(res) != PGRES_COMMAND_OK)
|
|
pgfdw_report_error(ERROR, res, fmstate->conn, true, fmstate->query);
|
|
PQclear(res);
|
|
|
|
/* This action shows that the prepare has been done. */
|
|
fmstate->p_name = p_name;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* convert_prep_stmt_params
|
|
* Create array of text strings representing parameter values
|
|
*
|
|
* tupleid is ctid to send, or NULL if none
|
|
* slot is slot to get remaining parameters from, or NULL if none
|
|
*
|
|
* Data is constructed in temp_cxt; caller should reset that after use.
|
|
*/
|
|
static const char **
|
|
convert_prep_stmt_params(PgFdwModifyState *fmstate,
|
|
ItemPointer tupleid,
|
|
TupleTableSlot **slots,
|
|
int numSlots)
|
|
{
|
|
const char **p_values;
|
|
int i;
|
|
int j;
|
|
int pindex = 0;
|
|
MemoryContext oldcontext;
|
|
|
|
oldcontext = MemoryContextSwitchTo(fmstate->temp_cxt);
|
|
|
|
p_values = (const char **) palloc(sizeof(char *) * fmstate->p_nums * numSlots);
|
|
|
|
/* ctid is provided only for UPDATE/DELETE, which don't allow batching */
|
|
Assert(!(tupleid != NULL && numSlots > 1));
|
|
|
|
/* 1st parameter should be ctid, if it's in use */
|
|
if (tupleid != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
Assert(numSlots == 1);
|
|
/* don't need set_transmission_modes for TID output */
|
|
p_values[pindex] = OutputFunctionCall(&fmstate->p_flinfo[pindex],
|
|
PointerGetDatum(tupleid));
|
|
pindex++;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* get following parameters from slots */
|
|
if (slots != NULL && fmstate->target_attrs != NIL)
|
|
{
|
|
TupleDesc tupdesc = RelationGetDescr(fmstate->rel);
|
|
int nestlevel;
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
nestlevel = set_transmission_modes();
|
|
|
|
for (i = 0; i < numSlots; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
j = (tupleid != NULL) ? 1 : 0;
|
|
foreach(lc, fmstate->target_attrs)
|
|
{
|
|
int attnum = lfirst_int(lc);
|
|
Form_pg_attribute attr = TupleDescAttr(tupdesc, attnum - 1);
|
|
Datum value;
|
|
bool isnull;
|
|
|
|
/* Ignore generated columns; they are set to DEFAULT */
|
|
if (attr->attgenerated)
|
|
continue;
|
|
value = slot_getattr(slots[i], attnum, &isnull);
|
|
if (isnull)
|
|
p_values[pindex] = NULL;
|
|
else
|
|
p_values[pindex] = OutputFunctionCall(&fmstate->p_flinfo[j],
|
|
value);
|
|
pindex++;
|
|
j++;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
reset_transmission_modes(nestlevel);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Assert(pindex == fmstate->p_nums * numSlots);
|
|
|
|
MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldcontext);
|
|
|
|
return p_values;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* store_returning_result
|
|
* Store the result of a RETURNING clause
|
|
*
|
|
* On error, be sure to release the PGresult on the way out. Callers do not
|
|
* have PG_TRY blocks to ensure this happens.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
store_returning_result(PgFdwModifyState *fmstate,
|
|
TupleTableSlot *slot, PGresult *res)
|
|
{
|
|
PG_TRY();
|
|
{
|
|
HeapTuple newtup;
|
|
|
|
newtup = make_tuple_from_result_row(res, 0,
|
|
fmstate->rel,
|
|
fmstate->attinmeta,
|
|
fmstate->retrieved_attrs,
|
|
NULL,
|
|
fmstate->temp_cxt);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* The returning slot will not necessarily be suitable to store
|
|
* heaptuples directly, so allow for conversion.
|
|
*/
|
|
ExecForceStoreHeapTuple(newtup, slot, true);
|
|
}
|
|
PG_CATCH();
|
|
{
|
|
if (res)
|
|
PQclear(res);
|
|
PG_RE_THROW();
|
|
}
|
|
PG_END_TRY();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* finish_foreign_modify
|
|
* Release resources for a foreign insert/update/delete operation
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
finish_foreign_modify(PgFdwModifyState *fmstate)
|
|
{
|
|
Assert(fmstate != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* If we created a prepared statement, destroy it */
|
|
deallocate_query(fmstate);
|
|
|
|
/* Release remote connection */
|
|
ReleaseConnection(fmstate->conn);
|
|
fmstate->conn = NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* deallocate_query
|
|
* Deallocate a prepared statement for a foreign insert/update/delete
|
|
* operation
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
deallocate_query(PgFdwModifyState *fmstate)
|
|
{
|
|
char sql[64];
|
|
PGresult *res;
|
|
|
|
/* do nothing if the query is not allocated */
|
|
if (!fmstate->p_name)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
snprintf(sql, sizeof(sql), "DEALLOCATE %s", fmstate->p_name);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* We don't use a PG_TRY block here, so be careful not to throw error
|
|
* without releasing the PGresult.
|
|
*/
|
|
res = pgfdw_exec_query(fmstate->conn, sql, fmstate->conn_state);
|
|
if (PQresultStatus(res) != PGRES_COMMAND_OK)
|
|
pgfdw_report_error(ERROR, res, fmstate->conn, true, sql);
|
|
PQclear(res);
|
|
pfree(fmstate->p_name);
|
|
fmstate->p_name = NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* build_remote_returning
|
|
* Build a RETURNING targetlist of a remote query for performing an
|
|
* UPDATE/DELETE .. RETURNING on a join directly
|
|
*/
|
|
static List *
|
|
build_remote_returning(Index rtindex, Relation rel, List *returningList)
|
|
{
|
|
bool have_wholerow = false;
|
|
List *tlist = NIL;
|
|
List *vars;
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
Assert(returningList);
|
|
|
|
vars = pull_var_clause((Node *) returningList, PVC_INCLUDE_PLACEHOLDERS);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If there's a whole-row reference to the target relation, then we'll
|
|
* need all the columns of the relation.
|
|
*/
|
|
foreach(lc, vars)
|
|
{
|
|
Var *var = (Var *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
|
|
if (IsA(var, Var) &&
|
|
var->varno == rtindex &&
|
|
var->varattno == InvalidAttrNumber)
|
|
{
|
|
have_wholerow = true;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (have_wholerow)
|
|
{
|
|
TupleDesc tupdesc = RelationGetDescr(rel);
|
|
int i;
|
|
|
|
for (i = 1; i <= tupdesc->natts; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
Form_pg_attribute attr = TupleDescAttr(tupdesc, i - 1);
|
|
Var *var;
|
|
|
|
/* Ignore dropped attributes. */
|
|
if (attr->attisdropped)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
var = makeVar(rtindex,
|
|
i,
|
|
attr->atttypid,
|
|
attr->atttypmod,
|
|
attr->attcollation,
|
|
0);
|
|
|
|
tlist = lappend(tlist,
|
|
makeTargetEntry((Expr *) var,
|
|
list_length(tlist) + 1,
|
|
NULL,
|
|
false));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Now add any remaining columns to tlist. */
|
|
foreach(lc, vars)
|
|
{
|
|
Var *var = (Var *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* No need for whole-row references to the target relation. We don't
|
|
* need system columns other than ctid and oid either, since those are
|
|
* set locally.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (IsA(var, Var) &&
|
|
var->varno == rtindex &&
|
|
var->varattno <= InvalidAttrNumber &&
|
|
var->varattno != SelfItemPointerAttributeNumber)
|
|
continue; /* don't need it */
|
|
|
|
if (tlist_member((Expr *) var, tlist))
|
|
continue; /* already got it */
|
|
|
|
tlist = lappend(tlist,
|
|
makeTargetEntry((Expr *) var,
|
|
list_length(tlist) + 1,
|
|
NULL,
|
|
false));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
list_free(vars);
|
|
|
|
return tlist;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* rebuild_fdw_scan_tlist
|
|
* Build new fdw_scan_tlist of given foreign-scan plan node from given
|
|
* tlist
|
|
*
|
|
* There might be columns that the fdw_scan_tlist of the given foreign-scan
|
|
* plan node contains that the given tlist doesn't. The fdw_scan_tlist would
|
|
* have contained resjunk columns such as 'ctid' of the target relation and
|
|
* 'wholerow' of non-target relations, but the tlist might not contain them,
|
|
* for example. So, adjust the tlist so it contains all the columns specified
|
|
* in the fdw_scan_tlist; else setrefs.c will get confused.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
rebuild_fdw_scan_tlist(ForeignScan *fscan, List *tlist)
|
|
{
|
|
List *new_tlist = tlist;
|
|
List *old_tlist = fscan->fdw_scan_tlist;
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
foreach(lc, old_tlist)
|
|
{
|
|
TargetEntry *tle = (TargetEntry *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
|
|
if (tlist_member(tle->expr, new_tlist))
|
|
continue; /* already got it */
|
|
|
|
new_tlist = lappend(new_tlist,
|
|
makeTargetEntry(tle->expr,
|
|
list_length(new_tlist) + 1,
|
|
NULL,
|
|
false));
|
|
}
|
|
fscan->fdw_scan_tlist = new_tlist;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Execute a direct UPDATE/DELETE statement.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
execute_dml_stmt(ForeignScanState *node)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwDirectModifyState *dmstate = (PgFdwDirectModifyState *) node->fdw_state;
|
|
ExprContext *econtext = node->ss.ps.ps_ExprContext;
|
|
int numParams = dmstate->numParams;
|
|
const char **values = dmstate->param_values;
|
|
|
|
/* First, process a pending asynchronous request, if any. */
|
|
if (dmstate->conn_state->pendingAreq)
|
|
process_pending_request(dmstate->conn_state->pendingAreq);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Construct array of query parameter values in text format.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (numParams > 0)
|
|
process_query_params(econtext,
|
|
dmstate->param_flinfo,
|
|
dmstate->param_exprs,
|
|
values);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Notice that we pass NULL for paramTypes, thus forcing the remote server
|
|
* to infer types for all parameters. Since we explicitly cast every
|
|
* parameter (see deparse.c), the "inference" is trivial and will produce
|
|
* the desired result. This allows us to avoid assuming that the remote
|
|
* server has the same OIDs we do for the parameters' types.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!PQsendQueryParams(dmstate->conn, dmstate->query, numParams,
|
|
NULL, values, NULL, NULL, 0))
|
|
pgfdw_report_error(ERROR, NULL, dmstate->conn, false, dmstate->query);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Get the result, and check for success.
|
|
*
|
|
* We don't use a PG_TRY block here, so be careful not to throw error
|
|
* without releasing the PGresult.
|
|
*/
|
|
dmstate->result = pgfdw_get_result(dmstate->conn, dmstate->query);
|
|
if (PQresultStatus(dmstate->result) !=
|
|
(dmstate->has_returning ? PGRES_TUPLES_OK : PGRES_COMMAND_OK))
|
|
pgfdw_report_error(ERROR, dmstate->result, dmstate->conn, true,
|
|
dmstate->query);
|
|
|
|
/* Get the number of rows affected. */
|
|
if (dmstate->has_returning)
|
|
dmstate->num_tuples = PQntuples(dmstate->result);
|
|
else
|
|
dmstate->num_tuples = atoi(PQcmdTuples(dmstate->result));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Get the result of a RETURNING clause.
|
|
*/
|
|
static TupleTableSlot *
|
|
get_returning_data(ForeignScanState *node)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwDirectModifyState *dmstate = (PgFdwDirectModifyState *) node->fdw_state;
|
|
EState *estate = node->ss.ps.state;
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo = node->resultRelInfo;
|
|
TupleTableSlot *slot = node->ss.ss_ScanTupleSlot;
|
|
TupleTableSlot *resultSlot;
|
|
|
|
Assert(resultRelInfo->ri_projectReturning);
|
|
|
|
/* If we didn't get any tuples, must be end of data. */
|
|
if (dmstate->next_tuple >= dmstate->num_tuples)
|
|
return ExecClearTuple(slot);
|
|
|
|
/* Increment the command es_processed count if necessary. */
|
|
if (dmstate->set_processed)
|
|
estate->es_processed += 1;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Store a RETURNING tuple. If has_returning is false, just emit a dummy
|
|
* tuple. (has_returning is false when the local query is of the form
|
|
* "UPDATE/DELETE .. RETURNING 1" for example.)
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!dmstate->has_returning)
|
|
{
|
|
ExecStoreAllNullTuple(slot);
|
|
resultSlot = slot;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/*
|
|
* On error, be sure to release the PGresult on the way out. Callers
|
|
* do not have PG_TRY blocks to ensure this happens.
|
|
*/
|
|
PG_TRY();
|
|
{
|
|
HeapTuple newtup;
|
|
|
|
newtup = make_tuple_from_result_row(dmstate->result,
|
|
dmstate->next_tuple,
|
|
dmstate->rel,
|
|
dmstate->attinmeta,
|
|
dmstate->retrieved_attrs,
|
|
node,
|
|
dmstate->temp_cxt);
|
|
ExecStoreHeapTuple(newtup, slot, false);
|
|
}
|
|
PG_CATCH();
|
|
{
|
|
if (dmstate->result)
|
|
PQclear(dmstate->result);
|
|
PG_RE_THROW();
|
|
}
|
|
PG_END_TRY();
|
|
|
|
/* Get the updated/deleted tuple. */
|
|
if (dmstate->rel)
|
|
resultSlot = slot;
|
|
else
|
|
resultSlot = apply_returning_filter(dmstate, resultRelInfo, slot, estate);
|
|
}
|
|
dmstate->next_tuple++;
|
|
|
|
/* Make slot available for evaluation of the local query RETURNING list. */
|
|
resultRelInfo->ri_projectReturning->pi_exprContext->ecxt_scantuple =
|
|
resultSlot;
|
|
|
|
return slot;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Initialize a filter to extract an updated/deleted tuple from a scan tuple.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
init_returning_filter(PgFdwDirectModifyState *dmstate,
|
|
List *fdw_scan_tlist,
|
|
Index rtindex)
|
|
{
|
|
TupleDesc resultTupType = RelationGetDescr(dmstate->resultRel);
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
int i;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Calculate the mapping between the fdw_scan_tlist's entries and the
|
|
* result tuple's attributes.
|
|
*
|
|
* The "map" is an array of indexes of the result tuple's attributes in
|
|
* fdw_scan_tlist, i.e., one entry for every attribute of the result
|
|
* tuple. We store zero for any attributes that don't have the
|
|
* corresponding entries in that list, marking that a NULL is needed in
|
|
* the result tuple.
|
|
*
|
|
* Also get the indexes of the entries for ctid and oid if any.
|
|
*/
|
|
dmstate->attnoMap = (AttrNumber *)
|
|
palloc0(resultTupType->natts * sizeof(AttrNumber));
|
|
|
|
dmstate->ctidAttno = dmstate->oidAttno = 0;
|
|
|
|
i = 1;
|
|
dmstate->hasSystemCols = false;
|
|
foreach(lc, fdw_scan_tlist)
|
|
{
|
|
TargetEntry *tle = (TargetEntry *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
Var *var = (Var *) tle->expr;
|
|
|
|
Assert(IsA(var, Var));
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If the Var is a column of the target relation to be retrieved from
|
|
* the foreign server, get the index of the entry.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (var->varno == rtindex &&
|
|
list_member_int(dmstate->retrieved_attrs, i))
|
|
{
|
|
int attrno = var->varattno;
|
|
|
|
if (attrno < 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/*
|
|
* We don't retrieve system columns other than ctid and oid.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (attrno == SelfItemPointerAttributeNumber)
|
|
dmstate->ctidAttno = i;
|
|
else
|
|
Assert(false);
|
|
dmstate->hasSystemCols = true;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/*
|
|
* We don't retrieve whole-row references to the target
|
|
* relation either.
|
|
*/
|
|
Assert(attrno > 0);
|
|
|
|
dmstate->attnoMap[attrno - 1] = i;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
i++;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Extract and return an updated/deleted tuple from a scan tuple.
|
|
*/
|
|
static TupleTableSlot *
|
|
apply_returning_filter(PgFdwDirectModifyState *dmstate,
|
|
ResultRelInfo *resultRelInfo,
|
|
TupleTableSlot *slot,
|
|
EState *estate)
|
|
{
|
|
TupleDesc resultTupType = RelationGetDescr(dmstate->resultRel);
|
|
TupleTableSlot *resultSlot;
|
|
Datum *values;
|
|
bool *isnull;
|
|
Datum *old_values;
|
|
bool *old_isnull;
|
|
int i;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Use the return tuple slot as a place to store the result tuple.
|
|
*/
|
|
resultSlot = ExecGetReturningSlot(estate, resultRelInfo);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Extract all the values of the scan tuple.
|
|
*/
|
|
slot_getallattrs(slot);
|
|
old_values = slot->tts_values;
|
|
old_isnull = slot->tts_isnull;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Prepare to build the result tuple.
|
|
*/
|
|
ExecClearTuple(resultSlot);
|
|
values = resultSlot->tts_values;
|
|
isnull = resultSlot->tts_isnull;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Transpose data into proper fields of the result tuple.
|
|
*/
|
|
for (i = 0; i < resultTupType->natts; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
int j = dmstate->attnoMap[i];
|
|
|
|
if (j == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
values[i] = (Datum) 0;
|
|
isnull[i] = true;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
values[i] = old_values[j - 1];
|
|
isnull[i] = old_isnull[j - 1];
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Build the virtual tuple.
|
|
*/
|
|
ExecStoreVirtualTuple(resultSlot);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If we have any system columns to return, materialize a heap tuple in
|
|
* the slot from column values set above and install system columns in
|
|
* that tuple.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (dmstate->hasSystemCols)
|
|
{
|
|
HeapTuple resultTup = ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(resultSlot, true, NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* ctid */
|
|
if (dmstate->ctidAttno)
|
|
{
|
|
ItemPointer ctid = NULL;
|
|
|
|
ctid = (ItemPointer) DatumGetPointer(old_values[dmstate->ctidAttno - 1]);
|
|
resultTup->t_self = *ctid;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* And remaining columns
|
|
*
|
|
* Note: since we currently don't allow the target relation to appear
|
|
* on the nullable side of an outer join, any system columns wouldn't
|
|
* go to NULL.
|
|
*
|
|
* Note: no need to care about tableoid here because it will be
|
|
* initialized in ExecProcessReturning().
|
|
*/
|
|
HeapTupleHeaderSetXmin(resultTup->t_data, InvalidTransactionId);
|
|
HeapTupleHeaderSetXmax(resultTup->t_data, InvalidTransactionId);
|
|
HeapTupleHeaderSetCmin(resultTup->t_data, InvalidTransactionId);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* And return the result tuple.
|
|
*/
|
|
return resultSlot;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Prepare for processing of parameters used in remote query.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
prepare_query_params(PlanState *node,
|
|
List *fdw_exprs,
|
|
int numParams,
|
|
FmgrInfo **param_flinfo,
|
|
List **param_exprs,
|
|
const char ***param_values)
|
|
{
|
|
int i;
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
Assert(numParams > 0);
|
|
|
|
/* Prepare for output conversion of parameters used in remote query. */
|
|
*param_flinfo = (FmgrInfo *) palloc0(sizeof(FmgrInfo) * numParams);
|
|
|
|
i = 0;
|
|
foreach(lc, fdw_exprs)
|
|
{
|
|
Node *param_expr = (Node *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
Oid typefnoid;
|
|
bool isvarlena;
|
|
|
|
getTypeOutputInfo(exprType(param_expr), &typefnoid, &isvarlena);
|
|
fmgr_info(typefnoid, &(*param_flinfo)[i]);
|
|
i++;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Prepare remote-parameter expressions for evaluation. (Note: in
|
|
* practice, we expect that all these expressions will be just Params, so
|
|
* we could possibly do something more efficient than using the full
|
|
* expression-eval machinery for this. But probably there would be little
|
|
* benefit, and it'd require postgres_fdw to know more than is desirable
|
|
* about Param evaluation.)
|
|
*/
|
|
*param_exprs = ExecInitExprList(fdw_exprs, node);
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate buffer for text form of query parameters. */
|
|
*param_values = (const char **) palloc0(numParams * sizeof(char *));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Construct array of query parameter values in text format.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
process_query_params(ExprContext *econtext,
|
|
FmgrInfo *param_flinfo,
|
|
List *param_exprs,
|
|
const char **param_values)
|
|
{
|
|
int nestlevel;
|
|
int i;
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
nestlevel = set_transmission_modes();
|
|
|
|
i = 0;
|
|
foreach(lc, param_exprs)
|
|
{
|
|
ExprState *expr_state = (ExprState *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
Datum expr_value;
|
|
bool isNull;
|
|
|
|
/* Evaluate the parameter expression */
|
|
expr_value = ExecEvalExpr(expr_state, econtext, &isNull);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Get string representation of each parameter value by invoking
|
|
* type-specific output function, unless the value is null.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (isNull)
|
|
param_values[i] = NULL;
|
|
else
|
|
param_values[i] = OutputFunctionCall(¶m_flinfo[i], expr_value);
|
|
|
|
i++;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
reset_transmission_modes(nestlevel);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresAnalyzeForeignTable
|
|
* Test whether analyzing this foreign table is supported
|
|
*/
|
|
static bool
|
|
postgresAnalyzeForeignTable(Relation relation,
|
|
AcquireSampleRowsFunc *func,
|
|
BlockNumber *totalpages)
|
|
{
|
|
ForeignTable *table;
|
|
UserMapping *user;
|
|
PGconn *conn;
|
|
StringInfoData sql;
|
|
PGresult *volatile res = NULL;
|
|
|
|
/* Return the row-analysis function pointer */
|
|
*func = postgresAcquireSampleRowsFunc;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Now we have to get the number of pages. It's annoying that the ANALYZE
|
|
* API requires us to return that now, because it forces some duplication
|
|
* of effort between this routine and postgresAcquireSampleRowsFunc. But
|
|
* it's probably not worth redefining that API at this point.
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Get the connection to use. We do the remote access as the table's
|
|
* owner, even if the ANALYZE was started by some other user.
|
|
*/
|
|
table = GetForeignTable(RelationGetRelid(relation));
|
|
user = GetUserMapping(relation->rd_rel->relowner, table->serverid);
|
|
conn = GetConnection(user, false, NULL);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Construct command to get page count for relation.
|
|
*/
|
|
initStringInfo(&sql);
|
|
deparseAnalyzeSizeSql(&sql, relation);
|
|
|
|
/* In what follows, do not risk leaking any PGresults. */
|
|
PG_TRY();
|
|
{
|
|
res = pgfdw_exec_query(conn, sql.data, NULL);
|
|
if (PQresultStatus(res) != PGRES_TUPLES_OK)
|
|
pgfdw_report_error(ERROR, res, conn, false, sql.data);
|
|
|
|
if (PQntuples(res) != 1 || PQnfields(res) != 1)
|
|
elog(ERROR, "unexpected result from deparseAnalyzeSizeSql query");
|
|
*totalpages = strtoul(PQgetvalue(res, 0, 0), NULL, 10);
|
|
}
|
|
PG_FINALLY();
|
|
{
|
|
if (res)
|
|
PQclear(res);
|
|
}
|
|
PG_END_TRY();
|
|
|
|
ReleaseConnection(conn);
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Acquire a random sample of rows from foreign table managed by postgres_fdw.
|
|
*
|
|
* We fetch the whole table from the remote side and pick out some sample rows.
|
|
*
|
|
* Selected rows are returned in the caller-allocated array rows[],
|
|
* which must have at least targrows entries.
|
|
* The actual number of rows selected is returned as the function result.
|
|
* We also count the total number of rows in the table and return it into
|
|
* *totalrows. Note that *totaldeadrows is always set to 0.
|
|
*
|
|
* Note that the returned list of rows is not always in order by physical
|
|
* position in the table. Therefore, correlation estimates derived later
|
|
* may be meaningless, but it's OK because we don't use the estimates
|
|
* currently (the planner only pays attention to correlation for indexscans).
|
|
*/
|
|
static int
|
|
postgresAcquireSampleRowsFunc(Relation relation, int elevel,
|
|
HeapTuple *rows, int targrows,
|
|
double *totalrows,
|
|
double *totaldeadrows)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwAnalyzeState astate;
|
|
ForeignTable *table;
|
|
ForeignServer *server;
|
|
UserMapping *user;
|
|
PGconn *conn;
|
|
unsigned int cursor_number;
|
|
StringInfoData sql;
|
|
PGresult *volatile res = NULL;
|
|
|
|
/* Initialize workspace state */
|
|
astate.rel = relation;
|
|
astate.attinmeta = TupleDescGetAttInMetadata(RelationGetDescr(relation));
|
|
|
|
astate.rows = rows;
|
|
astate.targrows = targrows;
|
|
astate.numrows = 0;
|
|
astate.samplerows = 0;
|
|
astate.rowstoskip = -1; /* -1 means not set yet */
|
|
reservoir_init_selection_state(&astate.rstate, targrows);
|
|
|
|
/* Remember ANALYZE context, and create a per-tuple temp context */
|
|
astate.anl_cxt = CurrentMemoryContext;
|
|
astate.temp_cxt = AllocSetContextCreate(CurrentMemoryContext,
|
|
"postgres_fdw temporary data",
|
|
ALLOCSET_SMALL_SIZES);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Get the connection to use. We do the remote access as the table's
|
|
* owner, even if the ANALYZE was started by some other user.
|
|
*/
|
|
table = GetForeignTable(RelationGetRelid(relation));
|
|
server = GetForeignServer(table->serverid);
|
|
user = GetUserMapping(relation->rd_rel->relowner, table->serverid);
|
|
conn = GetConnection(user, false, NULL);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Construct cursor that retrieves whole rows from remote.
|
|
*/
|
|
cursor_number = GetCursorNumber(conn);
|
|
initStringInfo(&sql);
|
|
appendStringInfo(&sql, "DECLARE c%u CURSOR FOR ", cursor_number);
|
|
deparseAnalyzeSql(&sql, relation, &astate.retrieved_attrs);
|
|
|
|
/* In what follows, do not risk leaking any PGresults. */
|
|
PG_TRY();
|
|
{
|
|
char fetch_sql[64];
|
|
int fetch_size;
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
res = pgfdw_exec_query(conn, sql.data, NULL);
|
|
if (PQresultStatus(res) != PGRES_COMMAND_OK)
|
|
pgfdw_report_error(ERROR, res, conn, false, sql.data);
|
|
PQclear(res);
|
|
res = NULL;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Determine the fetch size. The default is arbitrary, but shouldn't
|
|
* be enormous.
|
|
*/
|
|
fetch_size = 100;
|
|
foreach(lc, server->options)
|
|
{
|
|
DefElem *def = (DefElem *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
|
|
if (strcmp(def->defname, "fetch_size") == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
(void) parse_int(defGetString(def), &fetch_size, 0, NULL);
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
foreach(lc, table->options)
|
|
{
|
|
DefElem *def = (DefElem *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
|
|
if (strcmp(def->defname, "fetch_size") == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
(void) parse_int(defGetString(def), &fetch_size, 0, NULL);
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Construct command to fetch rows from remote. */
|
|
snprintf(fetch_sql, sizeof(fetch_sql), "FETCH %d FROM c%u",
|
|
fetch_size, cursor_number);
|
|
|
|
/* Retrieve and process rows a batch at a time. */
|
|
for (;;)
|
|
{
|
|
int numrows;
|
|
int i;
|
|
|
|
/* Allow users to cancel long query */
|
|
CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS();
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* XXX possible future improvement: if rowstoskip is large, we
|
|
* could issue a MOVE rather than physically fetching the rows,
|
|
* then just adjust rowstoskip and samplerows appropriately.
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
/* Fetch some rows */
|
|
res = pgfdw_exec_query(conn, fetch_sql, NULL);
|
|
/* On error, report the original query, not the FETCH. */
|
|
if (PQresultStatus(res) != PGRES_TUPLES_OK)
|
|
pgfdw_report_error(ERROR, res, conn, false, sql.data);
|
|
|
|
/* Process whatever we got. */
|
|
numrows = PQntuples(res);
|
|
for (i = 0; i < numrows; i++)
|
|
analyze_row_processor(res, i, &astate);
|
|
|
|
PQclear(res);
|
|
res = NULL;
|
|
|
|
/* Must be EOF if we didn't get all the rows requested. */
|
|
if (numrows < fetch_size)
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Close the cursor, just to be tidy. */
|
|
close_cursor(conn, cursor_number, NULL);
|
|
}
|
|
PG_CATCH();
|
|
{
|
|
if (res)
|
|
PQclear(res);
|
|
PG_RE_THROW();
|
|
}
|
|
PG_END_TRY();
|
|
|
|
ReleaseConnection(conn);
|
|
|
|
/* We assume that we have no dead tuple. */
|
|
*totaldeadrows = 0.0;
|
|
|
|
/* We've retrieved all living tuples from foreign server. */
|
|
*totalrows = astate.samplerows;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Emit some interesting relation info
|
|
*/
|
|
ereport(elevel,
|
|
(errmsg("\"%s\": table contains %.0f rows, %d rows in sample",
|
|
RelationGetRelationName(relation),
|
|
astate.samplerows, astate.numrows)));
|
|
|
|
return astate.numrows;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Collect sample rows from the result of query.
|
|
* - Use all tuples in sample until target # of samples are collected.
|
|
* - Subsequently, replace already-sampled tuples randomly.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
analyze_row_processor(PGresult *res, int row, PgFdwAnalyzeState *astate)
|
|
{
|
|
int targrows = astate->targrows;
|
|
int pos; /* array index to store tuple in */
|
|
MemoryContext oldcontext;
|
|
|
|
/* Always increment sample row counter. */
|
|
astate->samplerows += 1;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Determine the slot where this sample row should be stored. Set pos to
|
|
* negative value to indicate the row should be skipped.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (astate->numrows < targrows)
|
|
{
|
|
/* First targrows rows are always included into the sample */
|
|
pos = astate->numrows++;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/*
|
|
* Now we start replacing tuples in the sample until we reach the end
|
|
* of the relation. Same algorithm as in acquire_sample_rows in
|
|
* analyze.c; see Jeff Vitter's paper.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (astate->rowstoskip < 0)
|
|
astate->rowstoskip = reservoir_get_next_S(&astate->rstate, astate->samplerows, targrows);
|
|
|
|
if (astate->rowstoskip <= 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Choose a random reservoir element to replace. */
|
|
pos = (int) (targrows * sampler_random_fract(&astate->rstate.randstate));
|
|
Assert(pos >= 0 && pos < targrows);
|
|
heap_freetuple(astate->rows[pos]);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Skip this tuple. */
|
|
pos = -1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
astate->rowstoskip -= 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (pos >= 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/*
|
|
* Create sample tuple from current result row, and store it in the
|
|
* position determined above. The tuple has to be created in anl_cxt.
|
|
*/
|
|
oldcontext = MemoryContextSwitchTo(astate->anl_cxt);
|
|
|
|
astate->rows[pos] = make_tuple_from_result_row(res, row,
|
|
astate->rel,
|
|
astate->attinmeta,
|
|
astate->retrieved_attrs,
|
|
NULL,
|
|
astate->temp_cxt);
|
|
|
|
MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldcontext);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Import a foreign schema
|
|
*/
|
|
static List *
|
|
postgresImportForeignSchema(ImportForeignSchemaStmt *stmt, Oid serverOid)
|
|
{
|
|
List *commands = NIL;
|
|
bool import_collate = true;
|
|
bool import_default = false;
|
|
bool import_generated = true;
|
|
bool import_not_null = true;
|
|
ForeignServer *server;
|
|
UserMapping *mapping;
|
|
PGconn *conn;
|
|
StringInfoData buf;
|
|
PGresult *volatile res = NULL;
|
|
int numrows,
|
|
i;
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
/* Parse statement options */
|
|
foreach(lc, stmt->options)
|
|
{
|
|
DefElem *def = (DefElem *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
|
|
if (strcmp(def->defname, "import_collate") == 0)
|
|
import_collate = defGetBoolean(def);
|
|
else if (strcmp(def->defname, "import_default") == 0)
|
|
import_default = defGetBoolean(def);
|
|
else if (strcmp(def->defname, "import_generated") == 0)
|
|
import_generated = defGetBoolean(def);
|
|
else if (strcmp(def->defname, "import_not_null") == 0)
|
|
import_not_null = defGetBoolean(def);
|
|
else
|
|
ereport(ERROR,
|
|
(errcode(ERRCODE_FDW_INVALID_OPTION_NAME),
|
|
errmsg("invalid option \"%s\"", def->defname)));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Get connection to the foreign server. Connection manager will
|
|
* establish new connection if necessary.
|
|
*/
|
|
server = GetForeignServer(serverOid);
|
|
mapping = GetUserMapping(GetUserId(), server->serverid);
|
|
conn = GetConnection(mapping, false, NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* Don't attempt to import collation if remote server hasn't got it */
|
|
if (PQserverVersion(conn) < 90100)
|
|
import_collate = false;
|
|
|
|
/* Create workspace for strings */
|
|
initStringInfo(&buf);
|
|
|
|
/* In what follows, do not risk leaking any PGresults. */
|
|
PG_TRY();
|
|
{
|
|
/* Check that the schema really exists */
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&buf, "SELECT 1 FROM pg_catalog.pg_namespace WHERE nspname = ");
|
|
deparseStringLiteral(&buf, stmt->remote_schema);
|
|
|
|
res = pgfdw_exec_query(conn, buf.data, NULL);
|
|
if (PQresultStatus(res) != PGRES_TUPLES_OK)
|
|
pgfdw_report_error(ERROR, res, conn, false, buf.data);
|
|
|
|
if (PQntuples(res) != 1)
|
|
ereport(ERROR,
|
|
(errcode(ERRCODE_FDW_SCHEMA_NOT_FOUND),
|
|
errmsg("schema \"%s\" is not present on foreign server \"%s\"",
|
|
stmt->remote_schema, server->servername)));
|
|
|
|
PQclear(res);
|
|
res = NULL;
|
|
resetStringInfo(&buf);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Fetch all table data from this schema, possibly restricted by
|
|
* EXCEPT or LIMIT TO. (We don't actually need to pay any attention
|
|
* to EXCEPT/LIMIT TO here, because the core code will filter the
|
|
* statements we return according to those lists anyway. But it
|
|
* should save a few cycles to not process excluded tables in the
|
|
* first place.)
|
|
*
|
|
* Import table data for partitions only when they are explicitly
|
|
* specified in LIMIT TO clause. Otherwise ignore them and only
|
|
* include the definitions of the root partitioned tables to allow
|
|
* access to the complete remote data set locally in the schema
|
|
* imported.
|
|
*
|
|
* Note: because we run the connection with search_path restricted to
|
|
* pg_catalog, the format_type() and pg_get_expr() outputs will always
|
|
* include a schema name for types/functions in other schemas, which
|
|
* is what we want.
|
|
*/
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&buf,
|
|
"SELECT relname, "
|
|
" attname, "
|
|
" format_type(atttypid, atttypmod), "
|
|
" attnotnull, "
|
|
" pg_get_expr(adbin, adrelid), ");
|
|
|
|
/* Generated columns are supported since Postgres 12 */
|
|
if (PQserverVersion(conn) >= 120000)
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&buf,
|
|
" attgenerated, ");
|
|
else
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&buf,
|
|
" NULL, ");
|
|
|
|
if (import_collate)
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&buf,
|
|
" collname, "
|
|
" collnsp.nspname ");
|
|
else
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&buf,
|
|
" NULL, NULL ");
|
|
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&buf,
|
|
"FROM pg_class c "
|
|
" JOIN pg_namespace n ON "
|
|
" relnamespace = n.oid "
|
|
" LEFT JOIN pg_attribute a ON "
|
|
" attrelid = c.oid AND attnum > 0 "
|
|
" AND NOT attisdropped "
|
|
" LEFT JOIN pg_attrdef ad ON "
|
|
" adrelid = c.oid AND adnum = attnum ");
|
|
|
|
if (import_collate)
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&buf,
|
|
" LEFT JOIN pg_collation coll ON "
|
|
" coll.oid = attcollation "
|
|
" LEFT JOIN pg_namespace collnsp ON "
|
|
" collnsp.oid = collnamespace ");
|
|
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&buf,
|
|
"WHERE c.relkind IN ("
|
|
CppAsString2(RELKIND_RELATION) ","
|
|
CppAsString2(RELKIND_VIEW) ","
|
|
CppAsString2(RELKIND_FOREIGN_TABLE) ","
|
|
CppAsString2(RELKIND_MATVIEW) ","
|
|
CppAsString2(RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE) ") "
|
|
" AND n.nspname = ");
|
|
deparseStringLiteral(&buf, stmt->remote_schema);
|
|
|
|
/* Partitions are supported since Postgres 10 */
|
|
if (PQserverVersion(conn) >= 100000 &&
|
|
stmt->list_type != FDW_IMPORT_SCHEMA_LIMIT_TO)
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&buf, " AND NOT c.relispartition ");
|
|
|
|
/* Apply restrictions for LIMIT TO and EXCEPT */
|
|
if (stmt->list_type == FDW_IMPORT_SCHEMA_LIMIT_TO ||
|
|
stmt->list_type == FDW_IMPORT_SCHEMA_EXCEPT)
|
|
{
|
|
bool first_item = true;
|
|
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&buf, " AND c.relname ");
|
|
if (stmt->list_type == FDW_IMPORT_SCHEMA_EXCEPT)
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&buf, "NOT ");
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&buf, "IN (");
|
|
|
|
/* Append list of table names within IN clause */
|
|
foreach(lc, stmt->table_list)
|
|
{
|
|
RangeVar *rv = (RangeVar *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
|
|
if (first_item)
|
|
first_item = false;
|
|
else
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&buf, ", ");
|
|
deparseStringLiteral(&buf, rv->relname);
|
|
}
|
|
appendStringInfoChar(&buf, ')');
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Append ORDER BY at the end of query to ensure output ordering */
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&buf, " ORDER BY c.relname, a.attnum");
|
|
|
|
/* Fetch the data */
|
|
res = pgfdw_exec_query(conn, buf.data, NULL);
|
|
if (PQresultStatus(res) != PGRES_TUPLES_OK)
|
|
pgfdw_report_error(ERROR, res, conn, false, buf.data);
|
|
|
|
/* Process results */
|
|
numrows = PQntuples(res);
|
|
/* note: incrementation of i happens in inner loop's while() test */
|
|
for (i = 0; i < numrows;)
|
|
{
|
|
char *tablename = PQgetvalue(res, i, 0);
|
|
bool first_item = true;
|
|
|
|
resetStringInfo(&buf);
|
|
appendStringInfo(&buf, "CREATE FOREIGN TABLE %s (\n",
|
|
quote_identifier(tablename));
|
|
|
|
/* Scan all rows for this table */
|
|
do
|
|
{
|
|
char *attname;
|
|
char *typename;
|
|
char *attnotnull;
|
|
char *attgenerated;
|
|
char *attdefault;
|
|
char *collname;
|
|
char *collnamespace;
|
|
|
|
/* If table has no columns, we'll see nulls here */
|
|
if (PQgetisnull(res, i, 1))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
attname = PQgetvalue(res, i, 1);
|
|
typename = PQgetvalue(res, i, 2);
|
|
attnotnull = PQgetvalue(res, i, 3);
|
|
attdefault = PQgetisnull(res, i, 4) ? (char *) NULL :
|
|
PQgetvalue(res, i, 4);
|
|
attgenerated = PQgetisnull(res, i, 5) ? (char *) NULL :
|
|
PQgetvalue(res, i, 5);
|
|
collname = PQgetisnull(res, i, 6) ? (char *) NULL :
|
|
PQgetvalue(res, i, 6);
|
|
collnamespace = PQgetisnull(res, i, 7) ? (char *) NULL :
|
|
PQgetvalue(res, i, 7);
|
|
|
|
if (first_item)
|
|
first_item = false;
|
|
else
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&buf, ",\n");
|
|
|
|
/* Print column name and type */
|
|
appendStringInfo(&buf, " %s %s",
|
|
quote_identifier(attname),
|
|
typename);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Add column_name option so that renaming the foreign table's
|
|
* column doesn't break the association to the underlying
|
|
* column.
|
|
*/
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&buf, " OPTIONS (column_name ");
|
|
deparseStringLiteral(&buf, attname);
|
|
appendStringInfoChar(&buf, ')');
|
|
|
|
/* Add COLLATE if needed */
|
|
if (import_collate && collname != NULL && collnamespace != NULL)
|
|
appendStringInfo(&buf, " COLLATE %s.%s",
|
|
quote_identifier(collnamespace),
|
|
quote_identifier(collname));
|
|
|
|
/* Add DEFAULT if needed */
|
|
if (import_default && attdefault != NULL &&
|
|
(!attgenerated || !attgenerated[0]))
|
|
appendStringInfo(&buf, " DEFAULT %s", attdefault);
|
|
|
|
/* Add GENERATED if needed */
|
|
if (import_generated && attgenerated != NULL &&
|
|
attgenerated[0] == ATTRIBUTE_GENERATED_STORED)
|
|
{
|
|
Assert(attdefault != NULL);
|
|
appendStringInfo(&buf,
|
|
" GENERATED ALWAYS AS (%s) STORED",
|
|
attdefault);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Add NOT NULL if needed */
|
|
if (import_not_null && attnotnull[0] == 't')
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&buf, " NOT NULL");
|
|
}
|
|
while (++i < numrows &&
|
|
strcmp(PQgetvalue(res, i, 0), tablename) == 0);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Add server name and table-level options. We specify remote
|
|
* schema and table name as options (the latter to ensure that
|
|
* renaming the foreign table doesn't break the association).
|
|
*/
|
|
appendStringInfo(&buf, "\n) SERVER %s\nOPTIONS (",
|
|
quote_identifier(server->servername));
|
|
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&buf, "schema_name ");
|
|
deparseStringLiteral(&buf, stmt->remote_schema);
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&buf, ", table_name ");
|
|
deparseStringLiteral(&buf, tablename);
|
|
|
|
appendStringInfoString(&buf, ");");
|
|
|
|
commands = lappend(commands, pstrdup(buf.data));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
PG_FINALLY();
|
|
{
|
|
if (res)
|
|
PQclear(res);
|
|
}
|
|
PG_END_TRY();
|
|
|
|
ReleaseConnection(conn);
|
|
|
|
return commands;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Assess whether the join between inner and outer relations can be pushed down
|
|
* to the foreign server. As a side effect, save information we obtain in this
|
|
* function to PgFdwRelationInfo passed in.
|
|
*/
|
|
static bool
|
|
foreign_join_ok(PlannerInfo *root, RelOptInfo *joinrel, JoinType jointype,
|
|
RelOptInfo *outerrel, RelOptInfo *innerrel,
|
|
JoinPathExtraData *extra)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo;
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo_o;
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo_i;
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
List *joinclauses;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* We support pushing down INNER, LEFT, RIGHT and FULL OUTER joins.
|
|
* Constructing queries representing SEMI and ANTI joins is hard, hence
|
|
* not considered right now.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (jointype != JOIN_INNER && jointype != JOIN_LEFT &&
|
|
jointype != JOIN_RIGHT && jointype != JOIN_FULL)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If either of the joining relations is marked as unsafe to pushdown, the
|
|
* join can not be pushed down.
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo = (PgFdwRelationInfo *) joinrel->fdw_private;
|
|
fpinfo_o = (PgFdwRelationInfo *) outerrel->fdw_private;
|
|
fpinfo_i = (PgFdwRelationInfo *) innerrel->fdw_private;
|
|
if (!fpinfo_o || !fpinfo_o->pushdown_safe ||
|
|
!fpinfo_i || !fpinfo_i->pushdown_safe)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If joining relations have local conditions, those conditions are
|
|
* required to be applied before joining the relations. Hence the join can
|
|
* not be pushed down.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fpinfo_o->local_conds || fpinfo_i->local_conds)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Merge FDW options. We might be tempted to do this after we have deemed
|
|
* the foreign join to be OK. But we must do this beforehand so that we
|
|
* know which quals can be evaluated on the foreign server, which might
|
|
* depend on shippable_extensions.
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo->server = fpinfo_o->server;
|
|
merge_fdw_options(fpinfo, fpinfo_o, fpinfo_i);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Separate restrict list into join quals and pushed-down (other) quals.
|
|
*
|
|
* Join quals belonging to an outer join must all be shippable, else we
|
|
* cannot execute the join remotely. Add such quals to 'joinclauses'.
|
|
*
|
|
* Add other quals to fpinfo->remote_conds if they are shippable, else to
|
|
* fpinfo->local_conds. In an inner join it's okay to execute conditions
|
|
* either locally or remotely; the same is true for pushed-down conditions
|
|
* at an outer join.
|
|
*
|
|
* Note we might return failure after having already scribbled on
|
|
* fpinfo->remote_conds and fpinfo->local_conds. That's okay because we
|
|
* won't consult those lists again if we deem the join unshippable.
|
|
*/
|
|
joinclauses = NIL;
|
|
foreach(lc, extra->restrictlist)
|
|
{
|
|
RestrictInfo *rinfo = lfirst_node(RestrictInfo, lc);
|
|
bool is_remote_clause = is_foreign_expr(root, joinrel,
|
|
rinfo->clause);
|
|
|
|
if (IS_OUTER_JOIN(jointype) &&
|
|
!RINFO_IS_PUSHED_DOWN(rinfo, joinrel->relids))
|
|
{
|
|
if (!is_remote_clause)
|
|
return false;
|
|
joinclauses = lappend(joinclauses, rinfo);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_remote_clause)
|
|
fpinfo->remote_conds = lappend(fpinfo->remote_conds, rinfo);
|
|
else
|
|
fpinfo->local_conds = lappend(fpinfo->local_conds, rinfo);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* deparseExplicitTargetList() isn't smart enough to handle anything other
|
|
* than a Var. In particular, if there's some PlaceHolderVar that would
|
|
* need to be evaluated within this join tree (because there's an upper
|
|
* reference to a quantity that may go to NULL as a result of an outer
|
|
* join), then we can't try to push the join down because we'll fail when
|
|
* we get to deparseExplicitTargetList(). However, a PlaceHolderVar that
|
|
* needs to be evaluated *at the top* of this join tree is OK, because we
|
|
* can do that locally after fetching the results from the remote side.
|
|
*/
|
|
foreach(lc, root->placeholder_list)
|
|
{
|
|
PlaceHolderInfo *phinfo = lfirst(lc);
|
|
Relids relids;
|
|
|
|
/* PlaceHolderInfo refers to parent relids, not child relids. */
|
|
relids = IS_OTHER_REL(joinrel) ?
|
|
joinrel->top_parent_relids : joinrel->relids;
|
|
|
|
if (bms_is_subset(phinfo->ph_eval_at, relids) &&
|
|
bms_nonempty_difference(relids, phinfo->ph_eval_at))
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Save the join clauses, for later use. */
|
|
fpinfo->joinclauses = joinclauses;
|
|
|
|
fpinfo->outerrel = outerrel;
|
|
fpinfo->innerrel = innerrel;
|
|
fpinfo->jointype = jointype;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* By default, both the input relations are not required to be deparsed as
|
|
* subqueries, but there might be some relations covered by the input
|
|
* relations that are required to be deparsed as subqueries, so save the
|
|
* relids of those relations for later use by the deparser.
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo->make_outerrel_subquery = false;
|
|
fpinfo->make_innerrel_subquery = false;
|
|
Assert(bms_is_subset(fpinfo_o->lower_subquery_rels, outerrel->relids));
|
|
Assert(bms_is_subset(fpinfo_i->lower_subquery_rels, innerrel->relids));
|
|
fpinfo->lower_subquery_rels = bms_union(fpinfo_o->lower_subquery_rels,
|
|
fpinfo_i->lower_subquery_rels);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Pull the other remote conditions from the joining relations into join
|
|
* clauses or other remote clauses (remote_conds) of this relation
|
|
* wherever possible. This avoids building subqueries at every join step.
|
|
*
|
|
* For an inner join, clauses from both the relations are added to the
|
|
* other remote clauses. For LEFT and RIGHT OUTER join, the clauses from
|
|
* the outer side are added to remote_conds since those can be evaluated
|
|
* after the join is evaluated. The clauses from inner side are added to
|
|
* the joinclauses, since they need to be evaluated while constructing the
|
|
* join.
|
|
*
|
|
* For a FULL OUTER JOIN, the other clauses from either relation can not
|
|
* be added to the joinclauses or remote_conds, since each relation acts
|
|
* as an outer relation for the other.
|
|
*
|
|
* The joining sides can not have local conditions, thus no need to test
|
|
* shippability of the clauses being pulled up.
|
|
*/
|
|
switch (jointype)
|
|
{
|
|
case JOIN_INNER:
|
|
fpinfo->remote_conds = list_concat(fpinfo->remote_conds,
|
|
fpinfo_i->remote_conds);
|
|
fpinfo->remote_conds = list_concat(fpinfo->remote_conds,
|
|
fpinfo_o->remote_conds);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case JOIN_LEFT:
|
|
fpinfo->joinclauses = list_concat(fpinfo->joinclauses,
|
|
fpinfo_i->remote_conds);
|
|
fpinfo->remote_conds = list_concat(fpinfo->remote_conds,
|
|
fpinfo_o->remote_conds);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case JOIN_RIGHT:
|
|
fpinfo->joinclauses = list_concat(fpinfo->joinclauses,
|
|
fpinfo_o->remote_conds);
|
|
fpinfo->remote_conds = list_concat(fpinfo->remote_conds,
|
|
fpinfo_i->remote_conds);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case JOIN_FULL:
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* In this case, if any of the input relations has conditions, we
|
|
* need to deparse that relation as a subquery so that the
|
|
* conditions can be evaluated before the join. Remember it in
|
|
* the fpinfo of this relation so that the deparser can take
|
|
* appropriate action. Also, save the relids of base relations
|
|
* covered by that relation for later use by the deparser.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fpinfo_o->remote_conds)
|
|
{
|
|
fpinfo->make_outerrel_subquery = true;
|
|
fpinfo->lower_subquery_rels =
|
|
bms_add_members(fpinfo->lower_subquery_rels,
|
|
outerrel->relids);
|
|
}
|
|
if (fpinfo_i->remote_conds)
|
|
{
|
|
fpinfo->make_innerrel_subquery = true;
|
|
fpinfo->lower_subquery_rels =
|
|
bms_add_members(fpinfo->lower_subquery_rels,
|
|
innerrel->relids);
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
/* Should not happen, we have just checked this above */
|
|
elog(ERROR, "unsupported join type %d", jointype);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* For an inner join, all restrictions can be treated alike. Treating the
|
|
* pushed down conditions as join conditions allows a top level full outer
|
|
* join to be deparsed without requiring subqueries.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (jointype == JOIN_INNER)
|
|
{
|
|
Assert(!fpinfo->joinclauses);
|
|
fpinfo->joinclauses = fpinfo->remote_conds;
|
|
fpinfo->remote_conds = NIL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Mark that this join can be pushed down safely */
|
|
fpinfo->pushdown_safe = true;
|
|
|
|
/* Get user mapping */
|
|
if (fpinfo->use_remote_estimate)
|
|
{
|
|
if (fpinfo_o->use_remote_estimate)
|
|
fpinfo->user = fpinfo_o->user;
|
|
else
|
|
fpinfo->user = fpinfo_i->user;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
fpinfo->user = NULL;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Set # of retrieved rows and cached relation costs to some negative
|
|
* value, so that we can detect when they are set to some sensible values,
|
|
* during one (usually the first) of the calls to estimate_path_cost_size.
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo->retrieved_rows = -1;
|
|
fpinfo->rel_startup_cost = -1;
|
|
fpinfo->rel_total_cost = -1;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Set the string describing this join relation to be used in EXPLAIN
|
|
* output of corresponding ForeignScan. Note that the decoration we add
|
|
* to the base relation names mustn't include any digits, or it'll confuse
|
|
* postgresExplainForeignScan.
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo->relation_name = psprintf("(%s) %s JOIN (%s)",
|
|
fpinfo_o->relation_name,
|
|
get_jointype_name(fpinfo->jointype),
|
|
fpinfo_i->relation_name);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Set the relation index. This is defined as the position of this
|
|
* joinrel in the join_rel_list list plus the length of the rtable list.
|
|
* Note that since this joinrel is at the end of the join_rel_list list
|
|
* when we are called, we can get the position by list_length.
|
|
*/
|
|
Assert(fpinfo->relation_index == 0); /* shouldn't be set yet */
|
|
fpinfo->relation_index =
|
|
list_length(root->parse->rtable) + list_length(root->join_rel_list);
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
add_paths_with_pathkeys_for_rel(PlannerInfo *root, RelOptInfo *rel,
|
|
Path *epq_path)
|
|
{
|
|
List *useful_pathkeys_list = NIL; /* List of all pathkeys */
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
useful_pathkeys_list = get_useful_pathkeys_for_relation(root, rel);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Before creating sorted paths, arrange for the passed-in EPQ path, if
|
|
* any, to return columns needed by the parent ForeignScan node so that
|
|
* they will propagate up through Sort nodes injected below, if necessary.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (epq_path != NULL && useful_pathkeys_list != NIL)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo = (PgFdwRelationInfo *) rel->fdw_private;
|
|
PathTarget *target = copy_pathtarget(epq_path->pathtarget);
|
|
|
|
/* Include columns required for evaluating PHVs in the tlist. */
|
|
add_new_columns_to_pathtarget(target,
|
|
pull_var_clause((Node *) target->exprs,
|
|
PVC_RECURSE_PLACEHOLDERS));
|
|
|
|
/* Include columns required for evaluating the local conditions. */
|
|
foreach(lc, fpinfo->local_conds)
|
|
{
|
|
RestrictInfo *rinfo = lfirst_node(RestrictInfo, lc);
|
|
|
|
add_new_columns_to_pathtarget(target,
|
|
pull_var_clause((Node *) rinfo->clause,
|
|
PVC_RECURSE_PLACEHOLDERS));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If we have added any new columns, adjust the tlist of the EPQ path.
|
|
*
|
|
* Note: the plan created using this path will only be used to execute
|
|
* EPQ checks, where accuracy of the plan cost and width estimates
|
|
* would not be important, so we do not do set_pathtarget_cost_width()
|
|
* for the new pathtarget here. See also postgresGetForeignPlan().
|
|
*/
|
|
if (list_length(target->exprs) > list_length(epq_path->pathtarget->exprs))
|
|
{
|
|
/* The EPQ path is a join path, so it is projection-capable. */
|
|
Assert(is_projection_capable_path(epq_path));
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Use create_projection_path() here, so as to avoid modifying it
|
|
* in place.
|
|
*/
|
|
epq_path = (Path *) create_projection_path(root,
|
|
rel,
|
|
epq_path,
|
|
target);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Create one path for each set of pathkeys we found above. */
|
|
foreach(lc, useful_pathkeys_list)
|
|
{
|
|
double rows;
|
|
int width;
|
|
Cost startup_cost;
|
|
Cost total_cost;
|
|
List *useful_pathkeys = lfirst(lc);
|
|
Path *sorted_epq_path;
|
|
|
|
estimate_path_cost_size(root, rel, NIL, useful_pathkeys, NULL,
|
|
&rows, &width, &startup_cost, &total_cost);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* The EPQ path must be at least as well sorted as the path itself, in
|
|
* case it gets used as input to a mergejoin.
|
|
*/
|
|
sorted_epq_path = epq_path;
|
|
if (sorted_epq_path != NULL &&
|
|
!pathkeys_contained_in(useful_pathkeys,
|
|
sorted_epq_path->pathkeys))
|
|
sorted_epq_path = (Path *)
|
|
create_sort_path(root,
|
|
rel,
|
|
sorted_epq_path,
|
|
useful_pathkeys,
|
|
-1.0);
|
|
|
|
if (IS_SIMPLE_REL(rel))
|
|
add_path(rel, (Path *)
|
|
create_foreignscan_path(root, rel,
|
|
NULL,
|
|
rows,
|
|
startup_cost,
|
|
total_cost,
|
|
useful_pathkeys,
|
|
rel->lateral_relids,
|
|
sorted_epq_path,
|
|
NIL));
|
|
else
|
|
add_path(rel, (Path *)
|
|
create_foreign_join_path(root, rel,
|
|
NULL,
|
|
rows,
|
|
startup_cost,
|
|
total_cost,
|
|
useful_pathkeys,
|
|
rel->lateral_relids,
|
|
sorted_epq_path,
|
|
NIL));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Parse options from foreign server and apply them to fpinfo.
|
|
*
|
|
* New options might also require tweaking merge_fdw_options().
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
apply_server_options(PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo)
|
|
{
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
foreach(lc, fpinfo->server->options)
|
|
{
|
|
DefElem *def = (DefElem *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
|
|
if (strcmp(def->defname, "use_remote_estimate") == 0)
|
|
fpinfo->use_remote_estimate = defGetBoolean(def);
|
|
else if (strcmp(def->defname, "fdw_startup_cost") == 0)
|
|
(void) parse_real(defGetString(def), &fpinfo->fdw_startup_cost, 0,
|
|
NULL);
|
|
else if (strcmp(def->defname, "fdw_tuple_cost") == 0)
|
|
(void) parse_real(defGetString(def), &fpinfo->fdw_tuple_cost, 0,
|
|
NULL);
|
|
else if (strcmp(def->defname, "extensions") == 0)
|
|
fpinfo->shippable_extensions =
|
|
ExtractExtensionList(defGetString(def), false);
|
|
else if (strcmp(def->defname, "fetch_size") == 0)
|
|
(void) parse_int(defGetString(def), &fpinfo->fetch_size, 0, NULL);
|
|
else if (strcmp(def->defname, "async_capable") == 0)
|
|
fpinfo->async_capable = defGetBoolean(def);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Parse options from foreign table and apply them to fpinfo.
|
|
*
|
|
* New options might also require tweaking merge_fdw_options().
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
apply_table_options(PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo)
|
|
{
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
foreach(lc, fpinfo->table->options)
|
|
{
|
|
DefElem *def = (DefElem *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
|
|
if (strcmp(def->defname, "use_remote_estimate") == 0)
|
|
fpinfo->use_remote_estimate = defGetBoolean(def);
|
|
else if (strcmp(def->defname, "fetch_size") == 0)
|
|
(void) parse_int(defGetString(def), &fpinfo->fetch_size, 0, NULL);
|
|
else if (strcmp(def->defname, "async_capable") == 0)
|
|
fpinfo->async_capable = defGetBoolean(def);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Merge FDW options from input relations into a new set of options for a join
|
|
* or an upper rel.
|
|
*
|
|
* For a join relation, FDW-specific information about the inner and outer
|
|
* relations is provided using fpinfo_i and fpinfo_o. For an upper relation,
|
|
* fpinfo_o provides the information for the input relation; fpinfo_i is
|
|
* expected to NULL.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
merge_fdw_options(PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo,
|
|
const PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo_o,
|
|
const PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo_i)
|
|
{
|
|
/* We must always have fpinfo_o. */
|
|
Assert(fpinfo_o);
|
|
|
|
/* fpinfo_i may be NULL, but if present the servers must both match. */
|
|
Assert(!fpinfo_i ||
|
|
fpinfo_i->server->serverid == fpinfo_o->server->serverid);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Copy the server specific FDW options. (For a join, both relations come
|
|
* from the same server, so the server options should have the same value
|
|
* for both relations.)
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo->fdw_startup_cost = fpinfo_o->fdw_startup_cost;
|
|
fpinfo->fdw_tuple_cost = fpinfo_o->fdw_tuple_cost;
|
|
fpinfo->shippable_extensions = fpinfo_o->shippable_extensions;
|
|
fpinfo->use_remote_estimate = fpinfo_o->use_remote_estimate;
|
|
fpinfo->fetch_size = fpinfo_o->fetch_size;
|
|
fpinfo->async_capable = fpinfo_o->async_capable;
|
|
|
|
/* Merge the table level options from either side of the join. */
|
|
if (fpinfo_i)
|
|
{
|
|
/*
|
|
* We'll prefer to use remote estimates for this join if any table
|
|
* from either side of the join is using remote estimates. This is
|
|
* most likely going to be preferred since they're already willing to
|
|
* pay the price of a round trip to get the remote EXPLAIN. In any
|
|
* case it's not entirely clear how we might otherwise handle this
|
|
* best.
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo->use_remote_estimate = fpinfo_o->use_remote_estimate ||
|
|
fpinfo_i->use_remote_estimate;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Set fetch size to maximum of the joining sides, since we are
|
|
* expecting the rows returned by the join to be proportional to the
|
|
* relation sizes.
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo->fetch_size = Max(fpinfo_o->fetch_size, fpinfo_i->fetch_size);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* We'll prefer to consider this join async-capable if any table from
|
|
* either side of the join is considered async-capable. This would be
|
|
* reasonable because in that case the foreign server would have its
|
|
* own resources to scan that table asynchronously, and the join could
|
|
* also be computed asynchronously using the resources.
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo->async_capable = fpinfo_o->async_capable ||
|
|
fpinfo_i->async_capable;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresGetForeignJoinPaths
|
|
* Add possible ForeignPath to joinrel, if join is safe to push down.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
postgresGetForeignJoinPaths(PlannerInfo *root,
|
|
RelOptInfo *joinrel,
|
|
RelOptInfo *outerrel,
|
|
RelOptInfo *innerrel,
|
|
JoinType jointype,
|
|
JoinPathExtraData *extra)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo;
|
|
ForeignPath *joinpath;
|
|
double rows;
|
|
int width;
|
|
Cost startup_cost;
|
|
Cost total_cost;
|
|
Path *epq_path; /* Path to create plan to be executed when
|
|
* EvalPlanQual gets triggered. */
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Skip if this join combination has been considered already.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (joinrel->fdw_private)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* This code does not work for joins with lateral references, since those
|
|
* must have parameterized paths, which we don't generate yet.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!bms_is_empty(joinrel->lateral_relids))
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Create unfinished PgFdwRelationInfo entry which is used to indicate
|
|
* that the join relation is already considered, so that we won't waste
|
|
* time in judging safety of join pushdown and adding the same paths again
|
|
* if found safe. Once we know that this join can be pushed down, we fill
|
|
* the entry.
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo = (PgFdwRelationInfo *) palloc0(sizeof(PgFdwRelationInfo));
|
|
fpinfo->pushdown_safe = false;
|
|
joinrel->fdw_private = fpinfo;
|
|
/* attrs_used is only for base relations. */
|
|
fpinfo->attrs_used = NULL;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If there is a possibility that EvalPlanQual will be executed, we need
|
|
* to be able to reconstruct the row using scans of the base relations.
|
|
* GetExistingLocalJoinPath will find a suitable path for this purpose in
|
|
* the path list of the joinrel, if one exists. We must be careful to
|
|
* call it before adding any ForeignPath, since the ForeignPath might
|
|
* dominate the only suitable local path available. We also do it before
|
|
* calling foreign_join_ok(), since that function updates fpinfo and marks
|
|
* it as pushable if the join is found to be pushable.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (root->parse->commandType == CMD_DELETE ||
|
|
root->parse->commandType == CMD_UPDATE ||
|
|
root->rowMarks)
|
|
{
|
|
epq_path = GetExistingLocalJoinPath(joinrel);
|
|
if (!epq_path)
|
|
{
|
|
elog(DEBUG3, "could not push down foreign join because a local path suitable for EPQ checks was not found");
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
epq_path = NULL;
|
|
|
|
if (!foreign_join_ok(root, joinrel, jointype, outerrel, innerrel, extra))
|
|
{
|
|
/* Free path required for EPQ if we copied one; we don't need it now */
|
|
if (epq_path)
|
|
pfree(epq_path);
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Compute the selectivity and cost of the local_conds, so we don't have
|
|
* to do it over again for each path. The best we can do for these
|
|
* conditions is to estimate selectivity on the basis of local statistics.
|
|
* The local conditions are applied after the join has been computed on
|
|
* the remote side like quals in WHERE clause, so pass jointype as
|
|
* JOIN_INNER.
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo->local_conds_sel = clauselist_selectivity(root,
|
|
fpinfo->local_conds,
|
|
0,
|
|
JOIN_INNER,
|
|
NULL);
|
|
cost_qual_eval(&fpinfo->local_conds_cost, fpinfo->local_conds, root);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If we are going to estimate costs locally, estimate the join clause
|
|
* selectivity here while we have special join info.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!fpinfo->use_remote_estimate)
|
|
fpinfo->joinclause_sel = clauselist_selectivity(root, fpinfo->joinclauses,
|
|
0, fpinfo->jointype,
|
|
extra->sjinfo);
|
|
|
|
/* Estimate costs for bare join relation */
|
|
estimate_path_cost_size(root, joinrel, NIL, NIL, NULL,
|
|
&rows, &width, &startup_cost, &total_cost);
|
|
/* Now update this information in the joinrel */
|
|
joinrel->rows = rows;
|
|
joinrel->reltarget->width = width;
|
|
fpinfo->rows = rows;
|
|
fpinfo->width = width;
|
|
fpinfo->startup_cost = startup_cost;
|
|
fpinfo->total_cost = total_cost;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Create a new join path and add it to the joinrel which represents a
|
|
* join between foreign tables.
|
|
*/
|
|
joinpath = create_foreign_join_path(root,
|
|
joinrel,
|
|
NULL, /* default pathtarget */
|
|
rows,
|
|
startup_cost,
|
|
total_cost,
|
|
NIL, /* no pathkeys */
|
|
joinrel->lateral_relids,
|
|
epq_path,
|
|
NIL); /* no fdw_private */
|
|
|
|
/* Add generated path into joinrel by add_path(). */
|
|
add_path(joinrel, (Path *) joinpath);
|
|
|
|
/* Consider pathkeys for the join relation */
|
|
add_paths_with_pathkeys_for_rel(root, joinrel, epq_path);
|
|
|
|
/* XXX Consider parameterized paths for the join relation */
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Assess whether the aggregation, grouping and having operations can be pushed
|
|
* down to the foreign server. As a side effect, save information we obtain in
|
|
* this function to PgFdwRelationInfo of the input relation.
|
|
*/
|
|
static bool
|
|
foreign_grouping_ok(PlannerInfo *root, RelOptInfo *grouped_rel,
|
|
Node *havingQual)
|
|
{
|
|
Query *query = root->parse;
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo = (PgFdwRelationInfo *) grouped_rel->fdw_private;
|
|
PathTarget *grouping_target = grouped_rel->reltarget;
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *ofpinfo;
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
int i;
|
|
List *tlist = NIL;
|
|
|
|
/* We currently don't support pushing Grouping Sets. */
|
|
if (query->groupingSets)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
/* Get the fpinfo of the underlying scan relation. */
|
|
ofpinfo = (PgFdwRelationInfo *) fpinfo->outerrel->fdw_private;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If underlying scan relation has any local conditions, those conditions
|
|
* are required to be applied before performing aggregation. Hence the
|
|
* aggregate cannot be pushed down.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (ofpinfo->local_conds)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Examine grouping expressions, as well as other expressions we'd need to
|
|
* compute, and check whether they are safe to push down to the foreign
|
|
* server. All GROUP BY expressions will be part of the grouping target
|
|
* and thus there is no need to search for them separately. Add grouping
|
|
* expressions into target list which will be passed to foreign server.
|
|
*
|
|
* A tricky fine point is that we must not put any expression into the
|
|
* target list that is just a foreign param (that is, something that
|
|
* deparse.c would conclude has to be sent to the foreign server). If we
|
|
* do, the expression will also appear in the fdw_exprs list of the plan
|
|
* node, and setrefs.c will get confused and decide that the fdw_exprs
|
|
* entry is actually a reference to the fdw_scan_tlist entry, resulting in
|
|
* a broken plan. Somewhat oddly, it's OK if the expression contains such
|
|
* a node, as long as it's not at top level; then no match is possible.
|
|
*/
|
|
i = 0;
|
|
foreach(lc, grouping_target->exprs)
|
|
{
|
|
Expr *expr = (Expr *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
Index sgref = get_pathtarget_sortgroupref(grouping_target, i);
|
|
ListCell *l;
|
|
|
|
/* Check whether this expression is part of GROUP BY clause */
|
|
if (sgref && get_sortgroupref_clause_noerr(sgref, query->groupClause))
|
|
{
|
|
TargetEntry *tle;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If any GROUP BY expression is not shippable, then we cannot
|
|
* push down aggregation to the foreign server.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!is_foreign_expr(root, grouped_rel, expr))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If it would be a foreign param, we can't put it into the tlist,
|
|
* so we have to fail.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (is_foreign_param(root, grouped_rel, expr))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Pushable, so add to tlist. We need to create a TLE for this
|
|
* expression and apply the sortgroupref to it. We cannot use
|
|
* add_to_flat_tlist() here because that avoids making duplicate
|
|
* entries in the tlist. If there are duplicate entries with
|
|
* distinct sortgrouprefs, we have to duplicate that situation in
|
|
* the output tlist.
|
|
*/
|
|
tle = makeTargetEntry(expr, list_length(tlist) + 1, NULL, false);
|
|
tle->ressortgroupref = sgref;
|
|
tlist = lappend(tlist, tle);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/*
|
|
* Non-grouping expression we need to compute. Can we ship it
|
|
* as-is to the foreign server?
|
|
*/
|
|
if (is_foreign_expr(root, grouped_rel, expr) &&
|
|
!is_foreign_param(root, grouped_rel, expr))
|
|
{
|
|
/* Yes, so add to tlist as-is; OK to suppress duplicates */
|
|
tlist = add_to_flat_tlist(tlist, list_make1(expr));
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Not pushable as a whole; extract its Vars and aggregates */
|
|
List *aggvars;
|
|
|
|
aggvars = pull_var_clause((Node *) expr,
|
|
PVC_INCLUDE_AGGREGATES);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If any aggregate expression is not shippable, then we
|
|
* cannot push down aggregation to the foreign server. (We
|
|
* don't have to check is_foreign_param, since that certainly
|
|
* won't return true for any such expression.)
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!is_foreign_expr(root, grouped_rel, (Expr *) aggvars))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Add aggregates, if any, into the targetlist. Plain Vars
|
|
* outside an aggregate can be ignored, because they should be
|
|
* either same as some GROUP BY column or part of some GROUP
|
|
* BY expression. In either case, they are already part of
|
|
* the targetlist and thus no need to add them again. In fact
|
|
* including plain Vars in the tlist when they do not match a
|
|
* GROUP BY column would cause the foreign server to complain
|
|
* that the shipped query is invalid.
|
|
*/
|
|
foreach(l, aggvars)
|
|
{
|
|
Expr *expr = (Expr *) lfirst(l);
|
|
|
|
if (IsA(expr, Aggref))
|
|
tlist = add_to_flat_tlist(tlist, list_make1(expr));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
i++;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Classify the pushable and non-pushable HAVING clauses and save them in
|
|
* remote_conds and local_conds of the grouped rel's fpinfo.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (havingQual)
|
|
{
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
foreach(lc, (List *) havingQual)
|
|
{
|
|
Expr *expr = (Expr *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
RestrictInfo *rinfo;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Currently, the core code doesn't wrap havingQuals in
|
|
* RestrictInfos, so we must make our own.
|
|
*/
|
|
Assert(!IsA(expr, RestrictInfo));
|
|
rinfo = make_restrictinfo(root,
|
|
expr,
|
|
true,
|
|
false,
|
|
false,
|
|
root->qual_security_level,
|
|
grouped_rel->relids,
|
|
NULL,
|
|
NULL);
|
|
if (is_foreign_expr(root, grouped_rel, expr))
|
|
fpinfo->remote_conds = lappend(fpinfo->remote_conds, rinfo);
|
|
else
|
|
fpinfo->local_conds = lappend(fpinfo->local_conds, rinfo);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If there are any local conditions, pull Vars and aggregates from it and
|
|
* check whether they are safe to pushdown or not.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fpinfo->local_conds)
|
|
{
|
|
List *aggvars = NIL;
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
foreach(lc, fpinfo->local_conds)
|
|
{
|
|
RestrictInfo *rinfo = lfirst_node(RestrictInfo, lc);
|
|
|
|
aggvars = list_concat(aggvars,
|
|
pull_var_clause((Node *) rinfo->clause,
|
|
PVC_INCLUDE_AGGREGATES));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
foreach(lc, aggvars)
|
|
{
|
|
Expr *expr = (Expr *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If aggregates within local conditions are not safe to push
|
|
* down, then we cannot push down the query. Vars are already
|
|
* part of GROUP BY clause which are checked above, so no need to
|
|
* access them again here. Again, we need not check
|
|
* is_foreign_param for a foreign aggregate.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (IsA(expr, Aggref))
|
|
{
|
|
if (!is_foreign_expr(root, grouped_rel, expr))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
tlist = add_to_flat_tlist(tlist, list_make1(expr));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Store generated targetlist */
|
|
fpinfo->grouped_tlist = tlist;
|
|
|
|
/* Safe to pushdown */
|
|
fpinfo->pushdown_safe = true;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Set # of retrieved rows and cached relation costs to some negative
|
|
* value, so that we can detect when they are set to some sensible values,
|
|
* during one (usually the first) of the calls to estimate_path_cost_size.
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo->retrieved_rows = -1;
|
|
fpinfo->rel_startup_cost = -1;
|
|
fpinfo->rel_total_cost = -1;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Set the string describing this grouped relation to be used in EXPLAIN
|
|
* output of corresponding ForeignScan. Note that the decoration we add
|
|
* to the base relation name mustn't include any digits, or it'll confuse
|
|
* postgresExplainForeignScan.
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo->relation_name = psprintf("Aggregate on (%s)",
|
|
ofpinfo->relation_name);
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresGetForeignUpperPaths
|
|
* Add paths for post-join operations like aggregation, grouping etc. if
|
|
* corresponding operations are safe to push down.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
postgresGetForeignUpperPaths(PlannerInfo *root, UpperRelationKind stage,
|
|
RelOptInfo *input_rel, RelOptInfo *output_rel,
|
|
void *extra)
|
|
{
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If input rel is not safe to pushdown, then simply return as we cannot
|
|
* perform any post-join operations on the foreign server.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!input_rel->fdw_private ||
|
|
!((PgFdwRelationInfo *) input_rel->fdw_private)->pushdown_safe)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/* Ignore stages we don't support; and skip any duplicate calls. */
|
|
if ((stage != UPPERREL_GROUP_AGG &&
|
|
stage != UPPERREL_ORDERED &&
|
|
stage != UPPERREL_FINAL) ||
|
|
output_rel->fdw_private)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
fpinfo = (PgFdwRelationInfo *) palloc0(sizeof(PgFdwRelationInfo));
|
|
fpinfo->pushdown_safe = false;
|
|
fpinfo->stage = stage;
|
|
output_rel->fdw_private = fpinfo;
|
|
|
|
switch (stage)
|
|
{
|
|
case UPPERREL_GROUP_AGG:
|
|
add_foreign_grouping_paths(root, input_rel, output_rel,
|
|
(GroupPathExtraData *) extra);
|
|
break;
|
|
case UPPERREL_ORDERED:
|
|
add_foreign_ordered_paths(root, input_rel, output_rel);
|
|
break;
|
|
case UPPERREL_FINAL:
|
|
add_foreign_final_paths(root, input_rel, output_rel,
|
|
(FinalPathExtraData *) extra);
|
|
break;
|
|
default:
|
|
elog(ERROR, "unexpected upper relation: %d", (int) stage);
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* add_foreign_grouping_paths
|
|
* Add foreign path for grouping and/or aggregation.
|
|
*
|
|
* Given input_rel represents the underlying scan. The paths are added to the
|
|
* given grouped_rel.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
add_foreign_grouping_paths(PlannerInfo *root, RelOptInfo *input_rel,
|
|
RelOptInfo *grouped_rel,
|
|
GroupPathExtraData *extra)
|
|
{
|
|
Query *parse = root->parse;
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *ifpinfo = input_rel->fdw_private;
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo = grouped_rel->fdw_private;
|
|
ForeignPath *grouppath;
|
|
double rows;
|
|
int width;
|
|
Cost startup_cost;
|
|
Cost total_cost;
|
|
|
|
/* Nothing to be done, if there is no grouping or aggregation required. */
|
|
if (!parse->groupClause && !parse->groupingSets && !parse->hasAggs &&
|
|
!root->hasHavingQual)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
Assert(extra->patype == PARTITIONWISE_AGGREGATE_NONE ||
|
|
extra->patype == PARTITIONWISE_AGGREGATE_FULL);
|
|
|
|
/* save the input_rel as outerrel in fpinfo */
|
|
fpinfo->outerrel = input_rel;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Copy foreign table, foreign server, user mapping, FDW options etc.
|
|
* details from the input relation's fpinfo.
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo->table = ifpinfo->table;
|
|
fpinfo->server = ifpinfo->server;
|
|
fpinfo->user = ifpinfo->user;
|
|
merge_fdw_options(fpinfo, ifpinfo, NULL);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Assess if it is safe to push down aggregation and grouping.
|
|
*
|
|
* Use HAVING qual from extra. In case of child partition, it will have
|
|
* translated Vars.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!foreign_grouping_ok(root, grouped_rel, extra->havingQual))
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Compute the selectivity and cost of the local_conds, so we don't have
|
|
* to do it over again for each path. (Currently we create just a single
|
|
* path here, but in future it would be possible that we build more paths
|
|
* such as pre-sorted paths as in postgresGetForeignPaths and
|
|
* postgresGetForeignJoinPaths.) The best we can do for these conditions
|
|
* is to estimate selectivity on the basis of local statistics.
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo->local_conds_sel = clauselist_selectivity(root,
|
|
fpinfo->local_conds,
|
|
0,
|
|
JOIN_INNER,
|
|
NULL);
|
|
|
|
cost_qual_eval(&fpinfo->local_conds_cost, fpinfo->local_conds, root);
|
|
|
|
/* Estimate the cost of push down */
|
|
estimate_path_cost_size(root, grouped_rel, NIL, NIL, NULL,
|
|
&rows, &width, &startup_cost, &total_cost);
|
|
|
|
/* Now update this information in the fpinfo */
|
|
fpinfo->rows = rows;
|
|
fpinfo->width = width;
|
|
fpinfo->startup_cost = startup_cost;
|
|
fpinfo->total_cost = total_cost;
|
|
|
|
/* Create and add foreign path to the grouping relation. */
|
|
grouppath = create_foreign_upper_path(root,
|
|
grouped_rel,
|
|
grouped_rel->reltarget,
|
|
rows,
|
|
startup_cost,
|
|
total_cost,
|
|
NIL, /* no pathkeys */
|
|
NULL,
|
|
NIL); /* no fdw_private */
|
|
|
|
/* Add generated path into grouped_rel by add_path(). */
|
|
add_path(grouped_rel, (Path *) grouppath);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* add_foreign_ordered_paths
|
|
* Add foreign paths for performing the final sort remotely.
|
|
*
|
|
* Given input_rel contains the source-data Paths. The paths are added to the
|
|
* given ordered_rel.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
add_foreign_ordered_paths(PlannerInfo *root, RelOptInfo *input_rel,
|
|
RelOptInfo *ordered_rel)
|
|
{
|
|
Query *parse = root->parse;
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *ifpinfo = input_rel->fdw_private;
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo = ordered_rel->fdw_private;
|
|
PgFdwPathExtraData *fpextra;
|
|
double rows;
|
|
int width;
|
|
Cost startup_cost;
|
|
Cost total_cost;
|
|
List *fdw_private;
|
|
ForeignPath *ordered_path;
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
/* Shouldn't get here unless the query has ORDER BY */
|
|
Assert(parse->sortClause);
|
|
|
|
/* We don't support cases where there are any SRFs in the targetlist */
|
|
if (parse->hasTargetSRFs)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/* Save the input_rel as outerrel in fpinfo */
|
|
fpinfo->outerrel = input_rel;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Copy foreign table, foreign server, user mapping, FDW options etc.
|
|
* details from the input relation's fpinfo.
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo->table = ifpinfo->table;
|
|
fpinfo->server = ifpinfo->server;
|
|
fpinfo->user = ifpinfo->user;
|
|
merge_fdw_options(fpinfo, ifpinfo, NULL);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If the input_rel is a base or join relation, we would already have
|
|
* considered pushing down the final sort to the remote server when
|
|
* creating pre-sorted foreign paths for that relation, because the
|
|
* query_pathkeys is set to the root->sort_pathkeys in that case (see
|
|
* standard_qp_callback()).
|
|
*/
|
|
if (input_rel->reloptkind == RELOPT_BASEREL ||
|
|
input_rel->reloptkind == RELOPT_JOINREL)
|
|
{
|
|
Assert(root->query_pathkeys == root->sort_pathkeys);
|
|
|
|
/* Safe to push down if the query_pathkeys is safe to push down */
|
|
fpinfo->pushdown_safe = ifpinfo->qp_is_pushdown_safe;
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The input_rel should be a grouping relation */
|
|
Assert(input_rel->reloptkind == RELOPT_UPPER_REL &&
|
|
ifpinfo->stage == UPPERREL_GROUP_AGG);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* We try to create a path below by extending a simple foreign path for
|
|
* the underlying grouping relation to perform the final sort remotely,
|
|
* which is stored into the fdw_private list of the resulting path.
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
/* Assess if it is safe to push down the final sort */
|
|
foreach(lc, root->sort_pathkeys)
|
|
{
|
|
PathKey *pathkey = (PathKey *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
EquivalenceClass *pathkey_ec = pathkey->pk_eclass;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* is_foreign_expr would detect volatile expressions as well, but
|
|
* checking ec_has_volatile here saves some cycles.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (pathkey_ec->ec_has_volatile)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Can't push down the sort if pathkey's opfamily is not shippable.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!is_shippable(pathkey->pk_opfamily, OperatorFamilyRelationId,
|
|
fpinfo))
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* The EC must contain a shippable EM that is computed in input_rel's
|
|
* reltarget, else we can't push down the sort.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (find_em_for_rel_target(root,
|
|
pathkey_ec,
|
|
input_rel) == NULL)
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Safe to push down */
|
|
fpinfo->pushdown_safe = true;
|
|
|
|
/* Construct PgFdwPathExtraData */
|
|
fpextra = (PgFdwPathExtraData *) palloc0(sizeof(PgFdwPathExtraData));
|
|
fpextra->target = root->upper_targets[UPPERREL_ORDERED];
|
|
fpextra->has_final_sort = true;
|
|
|
|
/* Estimate the costs of performing the final sort remotely */
|
|
estimate_path_cost_size(root, input_rel, NIL, root->sort_pathkeys, fpextra,
|
|
&rows, &width, &startup_cost, &total_cost);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Build the fdw_private list that will be used by postgresGetForeignPlan.
|
|
* Items in the list must match order in enum FdwPathPrivateIndex.
|
|
*/
|
|
fdw_private = list_make2(makeBoolean(true), makeBoolean(false));
|
|
|
|
/* Create foreign ordering path */
|
|
ordered_path = create_foreign_upper_path(root,
|
|
input_rel,
|
|
root->upper_targets[UPPERREL_ORDERED],
|
|
rows,
|
|
startup_cost,
|
|
total_cost,
|
|
root->sort_pathkeys,
|
|
NULL, /* no extra plan */
|
|
fdw_private);
|
|
|
|
/* and add it to the ordered_rel */
|
|
add_path(ordered_rel, (Path *) ordered_path);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* add_foreign_final_paths
|
|
* Add foreign paths for performing the final processing remotely.
|
|
*
|
|
* Given input_rel contains the source-data Paths. The paths are added to the
|
|
* given final_rel.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
add_foreign_final_paths(PlannerInfo *root, RelOptInfo *input_rel,
|
|
RelOptInfo *final_rel,
|
|
FinalPathExtraData *extra)
|
|
{
|
|
Query *parse = root->parse;
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *ifpinfo = (PgFdwRelationInfo *) input_rel->fdw_private;
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo = (PgFdwRelationInfo *) final_rel->fdw_private;
|
|
bool has_final_sort = false;
|
|
List *pathkeys = NIL;
|
|
PgFdwPathExtraData *fpextra;
|
|
bool save_use_remote_estimate = false;
|
|
double rows;
|
|
int width;
|
|
Cost startup_cost;
|
|
Cost total_cost;
|
|
List *fdw_private;
|
|
ForeignPath *final_path;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Currently, we only support this for SELECT commands
|
|
*/
|
|
if (parse->commandType != CMD_SELECT)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* No work if there is no FOR UPDATE/SHARE clause and if there is no need
|
|
* to add a LIMIT node
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!parse->rowMarks && !extra->limit_needed)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/* We don't support cases where there are any SRFs in the targetlist */
|
|
if (parse->hasTargetSRFs)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/* Save the input_rel as outerrel in fpinfo */
|
|
fpinfo->outerrel = input_rel;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Copy foreign table, foreign server, user mapping, FDW options etc.
|
|
* details from the input relation's fpinfo.
|
|
*/
|
|
fpinfo->table = ifpinfo->table;
|
|
fpinfo->server = ifpinfo->server;
|
|
fpinfo->user = ifpinfo->user;
|
|
merge_fdw_options(fpinfo, ifpinfo, NULL);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If there is no need to add a LIMIT node, there might be a ForeignPath
|
|
* in the input_rel's pathlist that implements all behavior of the query.
|
|
* Note: we would already have accounted for the query's FOR UPDATE/SHARE
|
|
* (if any) before we get here.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!extra->limit_needed)
|
|
{
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
Assert(parse->rowMarks);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Grouping and aggregation are not supported with FOR UPDATE/SHARE,
|
|
* so the input_rel should be a base, join, or ordered relation; and
|
|
* if it's an ordered relation, its input relation should be a base or
|
|
* join relation.
|
|
*/
|
|
Assert(input_rel->reloptkind == RELOPT_BASEREL ||
|
|
input_rel->reloptkind == RELOPT_JOINREL ||
|
|
(input_rel->reloptkind == RELOPT_UPPER_REL &&
|
|
ifpinfo->stage == UPPERREL_ORDERED &&
|
|
(ifpinfo->outerrel->reloptkind == RELOPT_BASEREL ||
|
|
ifpinfo->outerrel->reloptkind == RELOPT_JOINREL)));
|
|
|
|
foreach(lc, input_rel->pathlist)
|
|
{
|
|
Path *path = (Path *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* apply_scanjoin_target_to_paths() uses create_projection_path()
|
|
* to adjust each of its input paths if needed, whereas
|
|
* create_ordered_paths() uses apply_projection_to_path() to do
|
|
* that. So the former might have put a ProjectionPath on top of
|
|
* the ForeignPath; look through ProjectionPath and see if the
|
|
* path underneath it is ForeignPath.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (IsA(path, ForeignPath) ||
|
|
(IsA(path, ProjectionPath) &&
|
|
IsA(((ProjectionPath *) path)->subpath, ForeignPath)))
|
|
{
|
|
/*
|
|
* Create foreign final path; this gets rid of a
|
|
* no-longer-needed outer plan (if any), which makes the
|
|
* EXPLAIN output look cleaner
|
|
*/
|
|
final_path = create_foreign_upper_path(root,
|
|
path->parent,
|
|
path->pathtarget,
|
|
path->rows,
|
|
path->startup_cost,
|
|
path->total_cost,
|
|
path->pathkeys,
|
|
NULL, /* no extra plan */
|
|
NULL); /* no fdw_private */
|
|
|
|
/* and add it to the final_rel */
|
|
add_path(final_rel, (Path *) final_path);
|
|
|
|
/* Safe to push down */
|
|
fpinfo->pushdown_safe = true;
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If we get here it means no ForeignPaths; since we would already
|
|
* have considered pushing down all operations for the query to the
|
|
* remote server, give up on it.
|
|
*/
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Assert(extra->limit_needed);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If the input_rel is an ordered relation, replace the input_rel with its
|
|
* input relation
|
|
*/
|
|
if (input_rel->reloptkind == RELOPT_UPPER_REL &&
|
|
ifpinfo->stage == UPPERREL_ORDERED)
|
|
{
|
|
input_rel = ifpinfo->outerrel;
|
|
ifpinfo = (PgFdwRelationInfo *) input_rel->fdw_private;
|
|
has_final_sort = true;
|
|
pathkeys = root->sort_pathkeys;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The input_rel should be a base, join, or grouping relation */
|
|
Assert(input_rel->reloptkind == RELOPT_BASEREL ||
|
|
input_rel->reloptkind == RELOPT_JOINREL ||
|
|
(input_rel->reloptkind == RELOPT_UPPER_REL &&
|
|
ifpinfo->stage == UPPERREL_GROUP_AGG));
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* We try to create a path below by extending a simple foreign path for
|
|
* the underlying base, join, or grouping relation to perform the final
|
|
* sort (if has_final_sort) and the LIMIT restriction remotely, which is
|
|
* stored into the fdw_private list of the resulting path. (We
|
|
* re-estimate the costs of sorting the underlying relation, if
|
|
* has_final_sort.)
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Assess if it is safe to push down the LIMIT and OFFSET to the remote
|
|
* server
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If the underlying relation has any local conditions, the LIMIT/OFFSET
|
|
* cannot be pushed down.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (ifpinfo->local_conds)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Also, the LIMIT/OFFSET cannot be pushed down, if their expressions are
|
|
* not safe to remote.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!is_foreign_expr(root, input_rel, (Expr *) parse->limitOffset) ||
|
|
!is_foreign_expr(root, input_rel, (Expr *) parse->limitCount))
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/* Safe to push down */
|
|
fpinfo->pushdown_safe = true;
|
|
|
|
/* Construct PgFdwPathExtraData */
|
|
fpextra = (PgFdwPathExtraData *) palloc0(sizeof(PgFdwPathExtraData));
|
|
fpextra->target = root->upper_targets[UPPERREL_FINAL];
|
|
fpextra->has_final_sort = has_final_sort;
|
|
fpextra->has_limit = extra->limit_needed;
|
|
fpextra->limit_tuples = extra->limit_tuples;
|
|
fpextra->count_est = extra->count_est;
|
|
fpextra->offset_est = extra->offset_est;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Estimate the costs of performing the final sort and the LIMIT
|
|
* restriction remotely. If has_final_sort is false, we wouldn't need to
|
|
* execute EXPLAIN anymore if use_remote_estimate, since the costs can be
|
|
* roughly estimated using the costs we already have for the underlying
|
|
* relation, in the same way as when use_remote_estimate is false. Since
|
|
* it's pretty expensive to execute EXPLAIN, force use_remote_estimate to
|
|
* false in that case.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!fpextra->has_final_sort)
|
|
{
|
|
save_use_remote_estimate = ifpinfo->use_remote_estimate;
|
|
ifpinfo->use_remote_estimate = false;
|
|
}
|
|
estimate_path_cost_size(root, input_rel, NIL, pathkeys, fpextra,
|
|
&rows, &width, &startup_cost, &total_cost);
|
|
if (!fpextra->has_final_sort)
|
|
ifpinfo->use_remote_estimate = save_use_remote_estimate;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Build the fdw_private list that will be used by postgresGetForeignPlan.
|
|
* Items in the list must match order in enum FdwPathPrivateIndex.
|
|
*/
|
|
fdw_private = list_make2(makeBoolean(has_final_sort),
|
|
makeBoolean(extra->limit_needed));
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Create foreign final path; this gets rid of a no-longer-needed outer
|
|
* plan (if any), which makes the EXPLAIN output look cleaner
|
|
*/
|
|
final_path = create_foreign_upper_path(root,
|
|
input_rel,
|
|
root->upper_targets[UPPERREL_FINAL],
|
|
rows,
|
|
startup_cost,
|
|
total_cost,
|
|
pathkeys,
|
|
NULL, /* no extra plan */
|
|
fdw_private);
|
|
|
|
/* and add it to the final_rel */
|
|
add_path(final_rel, (Path *) final_path);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresIsForeignPathAsyncCapable
|
|
* Check whether a given ForeignPath node is async-capable.
|
|
*/
|
|
static bool
|
|
postgresIsForeignPathAsyncCapable(ForeignPath *path)
|
|
{
|
|
RelOptInfo *rel = ((Path *) path)->parent;
|
|
PgFdwRelationInfo *fpinfo = (PgFdwRelationInfo *) rel->fdw_private;
|
|
|
|
return fpinfo->async_capable;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresForeignAsyncRequest
|
|
* Asynchronously request next tuple from a foreign PostgreSQL table.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
postgresForeignAsyncRequest(AsyncRequest *areq)
|
|
{
|
|
produce_tuple_asynchronously(areq, true);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresForeignAsyncConfigureWait
|
|
* Configure a file descriptor event for which we wish to wait.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
postgresForeignAsyncConfigureWait(AsyncRequest *areq)
|
|
{
|
|
ForeignScanState *node = (ForeignScanState *) areq->requestee;
|
|
PgFdwScanState *fsstate = (PgFdwScanState *) node->fdw_state;
|
|
AsyncRequest *pendingAreq = fsstate->conn_state->pendingAreq;
|
|
AppendState *requestor = (AppendState *) areq->requestor;
|
|
WaitEventSet *set = requestor->as_eventset;
|
|
|
|
/* This should not be called unless callback_pending */
|
|
Assert(areq->callback_pending);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If process_pending_request() has been invoked on the given request
|
|
* before we get here, we might have some tuples already; in which case
|
|
* complete the request
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fsstate->next_tuple < fsstate->num_tuples)
|
|
{
|
|
complete_pending_request(areq);
|
|
if (areq->request_complete)
|
|
return;
|
|
Assert(areq->callback_pending);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* We must have run out of tuples */
|
|
Assert(fsstate->next_tuple >= fsstate->num_tuples);
|
|
|
|
/* The core code would have registered postmaster death event */
|
|
Assert(GetNumRegisteredWaitEvents(set) >= 1);
|
|
|
|
/* Begin an asynchronous data fetch if not already done */
|
|
if (!pendingAreq)
|
|
fetch_more_data_begin(areq);
|
|
else if (pendingAreq->requestor != areq->requestor)
|
|
{
|
|
/*
|
|
* This is the case when the in-process request was made by another
|
|
* Append. Note that it might be useless to process the request,
|
|
* because the query might not need tuples from that Append anymore.
|
|
* If there are any child subplans of the same parent that are ready
|
|
* for new requests, skip the given request. Likewise, if there are
|
|
* any configured events other than the postmaster death event, skip
|
|
* it. Otherwise, process the in-process request, then begin a fetch
|
|
* to configure the event below, because we might otherwise end up
|
|
* with no configured events other than the postmaster death event.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (!bms_is_empty(requestor->as_needrequest))
|
|
return;
|
|
if (GetNumRegisteredWaitEvents(set) > 1)
|
|
return;
|
|
process_pending_request(pendingAreq);
|
|
fetch_more_data_begin(areq);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (pendingAreq->requestee != areq->requestee)
|
|
{
|
|
/*
|
|
* This is the case when the in-process request was made by the same
|
|
* parent but for a different child. Since we configure only the
|
|
* event for the request made for that child, skip the given request.
|
|
*/
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
Assert(pendingAreq == areq);
|
|
|
|
AddWaitEventToSet(set, WL_SOCKET_READABLE, PQsocket(fsstate->conn),
|
|
NULL, areq);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* postgresForeignAsyncNotify
|
|
* Fetch some more tuples from a file descriptor that becomes ready,
|
|
* requesting next tuple.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
postgresForeignAsyncNotify(AsyncRequest *areq)
|
|
{
|
|
ForeignScanState *node = (ForeignScanState *) areq->requestee;
|
|
PgFdwScanState *fsstate = (PgFdwScanState *) node->fdw_state;
|
|
|
|
/* The core code would have initialized the callback_pending flag */
|
|
Assert(!areq->callback_pending);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If process_pending_request() has been invoked on the given request
|
|
* before we get here, we might have some tuples already; in which case
|
|
* produce the next tuple
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fsstate->next_tuple < fsstate->num_tuples)
|
|
{
|
|
produce_tuple_asynchronously(areq, true);
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* We must have run out of tuples */
|
|
Assert(fsstate->next_tuple >= fsstate->num_tuples);
|
|
|
|
/* The request should be currently in-process */
|
|
Assert(fsstate->conn_state->pendingAreq == areq);
|
|
|
|
/* On error, report the original query, not the FETCH. */
|
|
if (!PQconsumeInput(fsstate->conn))
|
|
pgfdw_report_error(ERROR, NULL, fsstate->conn, false, fsstate->query);
|
|
|
|
fetch_more_data(node);
|
|
|
|
produce_tuple_asynchronously(areq, true);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Asynchronously produce next tuple from a foreign PostgreSQL table.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
produce_tuple_asynchronously(AsyncRequest *areq, bool fetch)
|
|
{
|
|
ForeignScanState *node = (ForeignScanState *) areq->requestee;
|
|
PgFdwScanState *fsstate = (PgFdwScanState *) node->fdw_state;
|
|
AsyncRequest *pendingAreq = fsstate->conn_state->pendingAreq;
|
|
TupleTableSlot *result;
|
|
|
|
/* This should not be called if the request is currently in-process */
|
|
Assert(areq != pendingAreq);
|
|
|
|
/* Fetch some more tuples, if we've run out */
|
|
if (fsstate->next_tuple >= fsstate->num_tuples)
|
|
{
|
|
/* No point in another fetch if we already detected EOF, though */
|
|
if (!fsstate->eof_reached)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Mark the request as pending for a callback */
|
|
ExecAsyncRequestPending(areq);
|
|
/* Begin another fetch if requested and if no pending request */
|
|
if (fetch && !pendingAreq)
|
|
fetch_more_data_begin(areq);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* There's nothing more to do; just return a NULL pointer */
|
|
result = NULL;
|
|
/* Mark the request as complete */
|
|
ExecAsyncRequestDone(areq, result);
|
|
}
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Get a tuple from the ForeignScan node */
|
|
result = areq->requestee->ExecProcNodeReal(areq->requestee);
|
|
if (!TupIsNull(result))
|
|
{
|
|
/* Mark the request as complete */
|
|
ExecAsyncRequestDone(areq, result);
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* We must have run out of tuples */
|
|
Assert(fsstate->next_tuple >= fsstate->num_tuples);
|
|
|
|
/* Fetch some more tuples, if we've not detected EOF yet */
|
|
if (!fsstate->eof_reached)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Mark the request as pending for a callback */
|
|
ExecAsyncRequestPending(areq);
|
|
/* Begin another fetch if requested and if no pending request */
|
|
if (fetch && !pendingAreq)
|
|
fetch_more_data_begin(areq);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* There's nothing more to do; just return a NULL pointer */
|
|
result = NULL;
|
|
/* Mark the request as complete */
|
|
ExecAsyncRequestDone(areq, result);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Begin an asynchronous data fetch.
|
|
*
|
|
* Note: this function assumes there is no currently-in-progress asynchronous
|
|
* data fetch.
|
|
*
|
|
* Note: fetch_more_data must be called to fetch the result.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
fetch_more_data_begin(AsyncRequest *areq)
|
|
{
|
|
ForeignScanState *node = (ForeignScanState *) areq->requestee;
|
|
PgFdwScanState *fsstate = (PgFdwScanState *) node->fdw_state;
|
|
char sql[64];
|
|
|
|
Assert(!fsstate->conn_state->pendingAreq);
|
|
|
|
/* Create the cursor synchronously. */
|
|
if (!fsstate->cursor_exists)
|
|
create_cursor(node);
|
|
|
|
/* We will send this query, but not wait for the response. */
|
|
snprintf(sql, sizeof(sql), "FETCH %d FROM c%u",
|
|
fsstate->fetch_size, fsstate->cursor_number);
|
|
|
|
if (!PQsendQuery(fsstate->conn, sql))
|
|
pgfdw_report_error(ERROR, NULL, fsstate->conn, false, fsstate->query);
|
|
|
|
/* Remember that the request is in process */
|
|
fsstate->conn_state->pendingAreq = areq;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Process a pending asynchronous request.
|
|
*/
|
|
void
|
|
process_pending_request(AsyncRequest *areq)
|
|
{
|
|
ForeignScanState *node = (ForeignScanState *) areq->requestee;
|
|
PgFdwScanState *fsstate = (PgFdwScanState *) node->fdw_state;
|
|
|
|
/* The request would have been pending for a callback */
|
|
Assert(areq->callback_pending);
|
|
|
|
/* The request should be currently in-process */
|
|
Assert(fsstate->conn_state->pendingAreq == areq);
|
|
|
|
fetch_more_data(node);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If we didn't get any tuples, must be end of data; complete the request
|
|
* now. Otherwise, we postpone completing the request until we are called
|
|
* from postgresForeignAsyncConfigureWait()/postgresForeignAsyncNotify().
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fsstate->next_tuple >= fsstate->num_tuples)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Unlike AsyncNotify, we unset callback_pending ourselves */
|
|
areq->callback_pending = false;
|
|
/* Mark the request as complete */
|
|
ExecAsyncRequestDone(areq, NULL);
|
|
/* Unlike AsyncNotify, we call ExecAsyncResponse ourselves */
|
|
ExecAsyncResponse(areq);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Complete a pending asynchronous request.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
complete_pending_request(AsyncRequest *areq)
|
|
{
|
|
/* The request would have been pending for a callback */
|
|
Assert(areq->callback_pending);
|
|
|
|
/* Unlike AsyncNotify, we unset callback_pending ourselves */
|
|
areq->callback_pending = false;
|
|
|
|
/* We begin a fetch afterwards if necessary; don't fetch */
|
|
produce_tuple_asynchronously(areq, false);
|
|
|
|
/* Unlike AsyncNotify, we call ExecAsyncResponse ourselves */
|
|
ExecAsyncResponse(areq);
|
|
|
|
/* Also, we do instrumentation ourselves, if required */
|
|
if (areq->requestee->instrument)
|
|
InstrUpdateTupleCount(areq->requestee->instrument,
|
|
TupIsNull(areq->result) ? 0.0 : 1.0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Create a tuple from the specified row of the PGresult.
|
|
*
|
|
* rel is the local representation of the foreign table, attinmeta is
|
|
* conversion data for the rel's tupdesc, and retrieved_attrs is an
|
|
* integer list of the table column numbers present in the PGresult.
|
|
* fsstate is the ForeignScan plan node's execution state.
|
|
* temp_context is a working context that can be reset after each tuple.
|
|
*
|
|
* Note: either rel or fsstate, but not both, can be NULL. rel is NULL
|
|
* if we're processing a remote join, while fsstate is NULL in a non-query
|
|
* context such as ANALYZE, or if we're processing a non-scan query node.
|
|
*/
|
|
static HeapTuple
|
|
make_tuple_from_result_row(PGresult *res,
|
|
int row,
|
|
Relation rel,
|
|
AttInMetadata *attinmeta,
|
|
List *retrieved_attrs,
|
|
ForeignScanState *fsstate,
|
|
MemoryContext temp_context)
|
|
{
|
|
HeapTuple tuple;
|
|
TupleDesc tupdesc;
|
|
Datum *values;
|
|
bool *nulls;
|
|
ItemPointer ctid = NULL;
|
|
ConversionLocation errpos;
|
|
ErrorContextCallback errcallback;
|
|
MemoryContext oldcontext;
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
int j;
|
|
|
|
Assert(row < PQntuples(res));
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Do the following work in a temp context that we reset after each tuple.
|
|
* This cleans up not only the data we have direct access to, but any
|
|
* cruft the I/O functions might leak.
|
|
*/
|
|
oldcontext = MemoryContextSwitchTo(temp_context);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Get the tuple descriptor for the row. Use the rel's tupdesc if rel is
|
|
* provided, otherwise look to the scan node's ScanTupleSlot.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (rel)
|
|
tupdesc = RelationGetDescr(rel);
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
Assert(fsstate);
|
|
tupdesc = fsstate->ss.ss_ScanTupleSlot->tts_tupleDescriptor;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
values = (Datum *) palloc0(tupdesc->natts * sizeof(Datum));
|
|
nulls = (bool *) palloc(tupdesc->natts * sizeof(bool));
|
|
/* Initialize to nulls for any columns not present in result */
|
|
memset(nulls, true, tupdesc->natts * sizeof(bool));
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Set up and install callback to report where conversion error occurs.
|
|
*/
|
|
errpos.cur_attno = 0;
|
|
errpos.rel = rel;
|
|
errpos.fsstate = fsstate;
|
|
errcallback.callback = conversion_error_callback;
|
|
errcallback.arg = (void *) &errpos;
|
|
errcallback.previous = error_context_stack;
|
|
error_context_stack = &errcallback;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* i indexes columns in the relation, j indexes columns in the PGresult.
|
|
*/
|
|
j = 0;
|
|
foreach(lc, retrieved_attrs)
|
|
{
|
|
int i = lfirst_int(lc);
|
|
char *valstr;
|
|
|
|
/* fetch next column's textual value */
|
|
if (PQgetisnull(res, row, j))
|
|
valstr = NULL;
|
|
else
|
|
valstr = PQgetvalue(res, row, j);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* convert value to internal representation
|
|
*
|
|
* Note: we ignore system columns other than ctid and oid in result
|
|
*/
|
|
errpos.cur_attno = i;
|
|
if (i > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* ordinary column */
|
|
Assert(i <= tupdesc->natts);
|
|
nulls[i - 1] = (valstr == NULL);
|
|
/* Apply the input function even to nulls, to support domains */
|
|
values[i - 1] = InputFunctionCall(&attinmeta->attinfuncs[i - 1],
|
|
valstr,
|
|
attinmeta->attioparams[i - 1],
|
|
attinmeta->atttypmods[i - 1]);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (i == SelfItemPointerAttributeNumber)
|
|
{
|
|
/* ctid */
|
|
if (valstr != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
Datum datum;
|
|
|
|
datum = DirectFunctionCall1(tidin, CStringGetDatum(valstr));
|
|
ctid = (ItemPointer) DatumGetPointer(datum);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
errpos.cur_attno = 0;
|
|
|
|
j++;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Uninstall error context callback. */
|
|
error_context_stack = errcallback.previous;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Check we got the expected number of columns. Note: j == 0 and
|
|
* PQnfields == 1 is expected, since deparse emits a NULL if no columns.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (j > 0 && j != PQnfields(res))
|
|
elog(ERROR, "remote query result does not match the foreign table");
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Build the result tuple in caller's memory context.
|
|
*/
|
|
MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldcontext);
|
|
|
|
tuple = heap_form_tuple(tupdesc, values, nulls);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If we have a CTID to return, install it in both t_self and t_ctid.
|
|
* t_self is the normal place, but if the tuple is converted to a
|
|
* composite Datum, t_self will be lost; setting t_ctid allows CTID to be
|
|
* preserved during EvalPlanQual re-evaluations (see ROW_MARK_COPY code).
|
|
*/
|
|
if (ctid)
|
|
tuple->t_self = tuple->t_data->t_ctid = *ctid;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Stomp on the xmin, xmax, and cmin fields from the tuple created by
|
|
* heap_form_tuple. heap_form_tuple actually creates the tuple with
|
|
* DatumTupleFields, not HeapTupleFields, but the executor expects
|
|
* HeapTupleFields and will happily extract system columns on that
|
|
* assumption. If we don't do this then, for example, the tuple length
|
|
* ends up in the xmin field, which isn't what we want.
|
|
*/
|
|
HeapTupleHeaderSetXmax(tuple->t_data, InvalidTransactionId);
|
|
HeapTupleHeaderSetXmin(tuple->t_data, InvalidTransactionId);
|
|
HeapTupleHeaderSetCmin(tuple->t_data, InvalidTransactionId);
|
|
|
|
/* Clean up */
|
|
MemoryContextReset(temp_context);
|
|
|
|
return tuple;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Callback function which is called when error occurs during column value
|
|
* conversion. Print names of column and relation.
|
|
*
|
|
* Note that this function mustn't do any catalog lookups, since we are in
|
|
* an already-failed transaction. Fortunately, we can get the needed info
|
|
* from the relation or the query's rangetable instead.
|
|
*/
|
|
static void
|
|
conversion_error_callback(void *arg)
|
|
{
|
|
ConversionLocation *errpos = (ConversionLocation *) arg;
|
|
Relation rel = errpos->rel;
|
|
ForeignScanState *fsstate = errpos->fsstate;
|
|
const char *attname = NULL;
|
|
const char *relname = NULL;
|
|
bool is_wholerow = false;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* If we're in a scan node, always use aliases from the rangetable, for
|
|
* consistency between the simple-relation and remote-join cases. Look at
|
|
* the relation's tupdesc only if we're not in a scan node.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (fsstate)
|
|
{
|
|
/* ForeignScan case */
|
|
ForeignScan *fsplan = castNode(ForeignScan, fsstate->ss.ps.plan);
|
|
int varno = 0;
|
|
AttrNumber colno = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (fsplan->scan.scanrelid > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* error occurred in a scan against a foreign table */
|
|
varno = fsplan->scan.scanrelid;
|
|
colno = errpos->cur_attno;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* error occurred in a scan against a foreign join */
|
|
TargetEntry *tle;
|
|
|
|
tle = list_nth_node(TargetEntry, fsplan->fdw_scan_tlist,
|
|
errpos->cur_attno - 1);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Target list can have Vars and expressions. For Vars, we can
|
|
* get some information, however for expressions we can't. Thus
|
|
* for expressions, just show generic context message.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (IsA(tle->expr, Var))
|
|
{
|
|
Var *var = (Var *) tle->expr;
|
|
|
|
varno = var->varno;
|
|
colno = var->varattno;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (varno > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
EState *estate = fsstate->ss.ps.state;
|
|
RangeTblEntry *rte = exec_rt_fetch(varno, estate);
|
|
|
|
relname = rte->eref->aliasname;
|
|
|
|
if (colno == 0)
|
|
is_wholerow = true;
|
|
else if (colno > 0 && colno <= list_length(rte->eref->colnames))
|
|
attname = strVal(list_nth(rte->eref->colnames, colno - 1));
|
|
else if (colno == SelfItemPointerAttributeNumber)
|
|
attname = "ctid";
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if (rel)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Non-ForeignScan case (we should always have a rel here) */
|
|
TupleDesc tupdesc = RelationGetDescr(rel);
|
|
|
|
relname = RelationGetRelationName(rel);
|
|
if (errpos->cur_attno > 0 && errpos->cur_attno <= tupdesc->natts)
|
|
{
|
|
Form_pg_attribute attr = TupleDescAttr(tupdesc,
|
|
errpos->cur_attno - 1);
|
|
|
|
attname = NameStr(attr->attname);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (errpos->cur_attno == SelfItemPointerAttributeNumber)
|
|
attname = "ctid";
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (relname && is_wholerow)
|
|
errcontext("whole-row reference to foreign table \"%s\"", relname);
|
|
else if (relname && attname)
|
|
errcontext("column \"%s\" of foreign table \"%s\"", attname, relname);
|
|
else
|
|
errcontext("processing expression at position %d in select list",
|
|
errpos->cur_attno);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Given an EquivalenceClass and a foreign relation, find an EC member
|
|
* that can be used to sort the relation remotely according to a pathkey
|
|
* using this EC.
|
|
*
|
|
* If there is more than one suitable candidate, return an arbitrary
|
|
* one of them. If there is none, return NULL.
|
|
*
|
|
* This checks that the EC member expression uses only Vars from the given
|
|
* rel and is shippable. Caller must separately verify that the pathkey's
|
|
* ordering operator is shippable.
|
|
*/
|
|
EquivalenceMember *
|
|
find_em_for_rel(PlannerInfo *root, EquivalenceClass *ec, RelOptInfo *rel)
|
|
{
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
foreach(lc, ec->ec_members)
|
|
{
|
|
EquivalenceMember *em = (EquivalenceMember *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Note we require !bms_is_empty, else we'd accept constant
|
|
* expressions which are not suitable for the purpose.
|
|
*/
|
|
if (bms_is_subset(em->em_relids, rel->relids) &&
|
|
!bms_is_empty(em->em_relids) &&
|
|
is_foreign_expr(root, rel, em->em_expr))
|
|
return em;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Find an EquivalenceClass member that is to be computed as a sort column
|
|
* in the given rel's reltarget, and is shippable.
|
|
*
|
|
* If there is more than one suitable candidate, return an arbitrary
|
|
* one of them. If there is none, return NULL.
|
|
*
|
|
* This checks that the EC member expression uses only Vars from the given
|
|
* rel and is shippable. Caller must separately verify that the pathkey's
|
|
* ordering operator is shippable.
|
|
*/
|
|
EquivalenceMember *
|
|
find_em_for_rel_target(PlannerInfo *root, EquivalenceClass *ec,
|
|
RelOptInfo *rel)
|
|
{
|
|
PathTarget *target = rel->reltarget;
|
|
ListCell *lc1;
|
|
int i;
|
|
|
|
i = 0;
|
|
foreach(lc1, target->exprs)
|
|
{
|
|
Expr *expr = (Expr *) lfirst(lc1);
|
|
Index sgref = get_pathtarget_sortgroupref(target, i);
|
|
ListCell *lc2;
|
|
|
|
/* Ignore non-sort expressions */
|
|
if (sgref == 0 ||
|
|
get_sortgroupref_clause_noerr(sgref,
|
|
root->parse->sortClause) == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
i++;
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* We ignore binary-compatible relabeling on both ends */
|
|
while (expr && IsA(expr, RelabelType))
|
|
expr = ((RelabelType *) expr)->arg;
|
|
|
|
/* Locate an EquivalenceClass member matching this expr, if any */
|
|
foreach(lc2, ec->ec_members)
|
|
{
|
|
EquivalenceMember *em = (EquivalenceMember *) lfirst(lc2);
|
|
Expr *em_expr;
|
|
|
|
/* Don't match constants */
|
|
if (em->em_is_const)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Ignore child members */
|
|
if (em->em_is_child)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Match if same expression (after stripping relabel) */
|
|
em_expr = em->em_expr;
|
|
while (em_expr && IsA(em_expr, RelabelType))
|
|
em_expr = ((RelabelType *) em_expr)->arg;
|
|
|
|
if (!equal(em_expr, expr))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Check that expression (including relabels!) is shippable */
|
|
if (is_foreign_expr(root, rel, em->em_expr))
|
|
return em;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
i++;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Determine batch size for a given foreign table. The option specified for
|
|
* a table has precedence.
|
|
*/
|
|
static int
|
|
get_batch_size_option(Relation rel)
|
|
{
|
|
Oid foreigntableid = RelationGetRelid(rel);
|
|
ForeignTable *table;
|
|
ForeignServer *server;
|
|
List *options;
|
|
ListCell *lc;
|
|
|
|
/* we use 1 by default, which means "no batching" */
|
|
int batch_size = 1;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
* Load options for table and server. We append server options after table
|
|
* options, because table options take precedence.
|
|
*/
|
|
table = GetForeignTable(foreigntableid);
|
|
server = GetForeignServer(table->serverid);
|
|
|
|
options = NIL;
|
|
options = list_concat(options, table->options);
|
|
options = list_concat(options, server->options);
|
|
|
|
/* See if either table or server specifies batch_size. */
|
|
foreach(lc, options)
|
|
{
|
|
DefElem *def = (DefElem *) lfirst(lc);
|
|
|
|
if (strcmp(def->defname, "batch_size") == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
(void) parse_int(defGetString(def), &batch_size, 0, NULL);
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return batch_size;
|
|
}
|